Wording improvement for forbidding duplicate fields
[debian-policy.git] / policy.sgml
blob21c1c7e35df73a53b31a0145230d142a27acfef3
1 <!doctype debiandoc system [
2 <!-- include version information so we don't have to hard code it
3 within the document -->
4 <!entity % versiondata SYSTEM "version.ent"> %versiondata;
5 ]>
6 <debiandoc>
8 <book>
9 <titlepag>
10 <title>Debian Policy Manual</title>
11 <author><qref id="authors">The Debian Policy Mailing List</qref></author>
12 <version>version &version;, &date;</version>
14 <abstract>
15 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
16 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
17 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of
18 the operating system, as well as technical requirements that
19 each package must satisfy to be included in the distribution.
20 </abstract>
22 <copyright>
23 <copyrightsummary>
24 Copyright &copy; 1996,1997,1998 Ian Jackson
25 and Christian Schwarz.
26 </copyrightsummary>
27 <p>
28 These are the copyright dates of the original Policy manual.
29 Since then, this manual has been updated by many others. No
30 comprehensive collection of copyright notices for subsequent
31 work exists.
32 </p>
34 <p>
35 This manual is free software; you may redistribute it and/or
36 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
37 as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version
38 2, or (at your option) any later version.
39 </p>
41 <p>
42 This is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
43 <em>without any warranty</em>; without even the implied
44 warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular
45 purpose. See the GNU General Public License for more
46 details.
47 </p>
49 <p>
50 A copy of the GNU General Public License is available as
51 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL</file> in the Debian GNU/Linux
52 distribution or on the World Wide Web at
53 <url id="http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html"
54 name="the GNU General Public Licence">. You can also
55 obtain it by writing to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
56 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
57 </p>
58 </copyright>
59 </titlepag>
61 <toc detail="sect1">
63 <chapt id="scope">
64 <heading>About this manual</heading>
65 <sect>
66 <heading>Scope</heading>
67 <p>
68 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
69 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
70 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of the
71 operating system, as well as technical requirements that
72 each package must satisfy to be included in the
73 distribution.
74 </p>
76 <p>
77 This manual also describes Debian policy as it relates to
78 creating Debian packages. It is not a tutorial on how to build
79 packages, nor is it exhaustive where it comes to describing
80 the behavior of the packaging system. Instead, this manual
81 attempts to define the interface to the package management
82 system that the developers have to be conversant with.<footnote>
83 Informally, the criteria used for inclusion is that the
84 material meet one of the following requirements:
85 <taglist compact="compact">
86 <tag>Standard interfaces</tag>
87 <item>
88 The material presented represents an interface to
89 the packaging system that is mandated for use, and
90 is used by, a significant number of packages, and
91 therefore should not be changed without peer
92 review. Package maintainers can then rely on this
93 interface not changing, and the package management
94 software authors need to ensure compatibility with
95 this interface definition. (Control file and
96 changelog file formats are examples.)
97 </item>
98 <tag>Chosen Convention</tag>
99 <item>
100 If there are a number of technically viable choices
101 that can be made, but one needs to select one of
102 these options for inter-operability. The version
103 number format is one example.
104 </item>
105 </taglist>
106 Please note that these are not mutually exclusive;
107 selected conventions often become parts of standard
108 interfaces.
109 </footnote>
110 </p>
113 The footnotes present in this manual are
114 merely informative, and are not part of Debian policy itself.
115 </p>
118 The appendices to this manual are not necessarily normative,
119 either. Please see <ref id="pkg-scope"> for more information.
120 </p>
123 In the normative part of this manual,
124 the words <em>must</em>, <em>should</em> and
125 <em>may</em>, and the adjectives <em>required</em>,
126 <em>recommended</em> and <em>optional</em>, are used to
127 distinguish the significance of the various guidelines in
128 this policy document. Packages that do not conform to the
129 guidelines denoted by <em>must</em> (or <em>required</em>)
130 will generally not be considered acceptable for the Debian
131 distribution. Non-conformance with guidelines denoted by
132 <em>should</em> (or <em>recommended</em>) will generally be
133 considered a bug, but will not necessarily render a package
134 unsuitable for distribution. Guidelines denoted by
135 <em>may</em> (or <em>optional</em>) are truly optional and
136 adherence is left to the maintainer's discretion.
137 </p>
140 These classifications are roughly equivalent to the bug
141 severities <em>serious</em> (for <em>must</em> or
142 <em>required</em> directive violations), <em>minor</em>,
143 <em>normal</em> or <em>important</em>
144 (for <em>should</em> or <em>recommended</em> directive
145 violations) and <em>wishlist</em> (for <em>optional</em>
146 items).
147 <footnote>
148 Compare RFC 2119. Note, however, that these words are
149 used in a different way in this document.
150 </footnote>
151 </p>
154 Much of the information presented in this manual will be
155 useful even when building a package which is to be
156 distributed in some other way or is intended for local use
157 only.
158 </p>
159 </sect>
161 <sect>
162 <heading>New versions of this document</heading>
165 This manual is distributed via the Debian package
166 <package><url name="debian-policy"
167 id="http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy"></package>
168 (<httpsite>packages.debian.org</httpsite>
169 <httppath>/debian-policy</httppath>).
170 </p>
173 The current version of this document is also available from
174 the Debian web mirrors at
175 <tt><url name="/doc/debian-policy/"
176 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/"></tt>.
178 <httpsite>www.debian.org</httpsite>
179 <httppath>/doc/debian-policy/</httppath>)
180 Also available from the same directory are several other
181 formats: <file>policy.html.tar.gz</file>
182 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.html.tar.gz</httppath>),
183 <file>policy.pdf.gz</file>
184 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.pdf.gz</httppath>)
185 and <file>policy.ps.gz</file>
186 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.ps.gz</httppath>).
187 </p>
190 The <package>debian-policy</package> package also includes the file
191 <file>upgrading-checklist.txt.gz</file> which indicates policy
192 changes between versions of this document.
193 </p>
194 </sect>
196 <sect id="authors">
197 <heading>Authors and Maintainers</heading>
200 Originally called "Debian GNU/Linux Policy Manual", this
201 manual was initially written in 1996 by Ian Jackson.
202 It was revised on November 27th, 1996 by David A. Morris.
203 Christian Schwarz added new sections on March 15th, 1997,
204 and reworked/restructured it in April-July 1997.
205 Christoph Lameter contributed the "Web Standard".
206 Julian Gilbey largely restructured it in 2001.
207 </p>
210 Since September 1998, the responsibility for the contents of
211 this document lies on the <url name="debian-policy mailing list"
212 id="mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org">. Proposals
213 are discussed there and inserted into policy after a certain
214 consensus is established.
215 <!-- insert shameless policy-process plug here eventually -->
216 The actual editing is done by a group of maintainers that have
217 no editorial powers. These are the current maintainers:
219 <enumlist>
220 <item>Julian Gilbey</item>
221 <item>Branden Robinson</item>
222 <item>Josip Rodin</item>
223 <item>Manoj Srivastava</item>
224 </enumlist>
225 </p>
228 While the authors of this document have tried hard to avoid
229 typos and other errors, these do still occur. If you discover
230 an error in this manual or if you want to give any
231 comments, suggestions, or criticisms please send an email to
232 the Debian Policy List,
233 <email>debian-policy@lists.debian.org</email>, or submit a
234 bug report against the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
235 </p>
238 Please do not try to reach the individual authors or maintainers
239 of the Policy Manual regarding changes to the Policy.
240 </p>
241 </sect>
243 <sect id="related">
244 <heading>Related documents</heading>
247 There are several other documents other than this Policy Manual
248 that are necessary to fully understand some Debian policies and
249 procedures.
250 </p>
253 The external "sub-policy" documents are referred to in:
254 <list compact="compact">
255 <item><ref id="fhs"></item>
256 <item><ref id="virtual_pkg"></item>
257 <item><ref id="menus"></item>
258 <item><ref id="mime"></item>
259 <item><ref id="perl"></item>
260 <item><ref id="maintscriptprompt"></item>
261 <item><ref id="emacs"></item>
262 </list>
263 </p>
266 In addition to those, which carry the weight of policy, there
267 is the Debian Developer's Reference. This document describes
268 procedures and resources for Debian developers, but it is
269 <em>not</em> normative; rather, it includes things that don't
270 belong in the Policy, such as best practices for developers.
271 </p>
274 The Developer's Reference is available in the
275 <package>developers-reference</package> package.
276 It's also available from the Debian web mirrors at
277 <tt><url name="/doc/developers-reference/"
278 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/developers-reference/"></tt>.
279 </p>
280 </sect>
282 <sect id="definitions">
283 <heading>Definitions</heading>
286 The following terms are used in this Policy Manual:
287 <taglist>
288 <tag>ASCII</tag>
289 <item>
290 The character encoding specified by ANSI X3.4-1986 and its
291 predecessor standards, referred to in MIME as US-ASCII, and
292 corresponding to an encoding in eight bits per character of
293 the first 128 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/"
294 name="Unicode"> characters, with the eighth bit always zero.
295 </item>
296 <tag>UTF-8</tag>
297 <item>
298 The transformation format (sometimes called encoding) of
299 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/" name="Unicode"> defined by
300 <url id="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3629.txt"
301 name="RFC 3629">. UTF-8 has the useful property of having
302 ASCII as a subset, so any text encoded in ASCII is trivially
303 also valid UTF-8.
304 </item>
305 </taglist>
306 </p>
307 </sect>
308 </chapt>
311 <chapt id="archive">
312 <heading>The Debian Archive</heading>
315 The Debian GNU/Linux system is maintained and distributed as a
316 collection of <em>packages</em>. Since there are so many of
317 them (currently well over 15000), they are split into
318 <em>sections</em> and given <em>priorities</em> to simplify
319 the handling of them.
320 </p>
323 The effort of the Debian project is to build a free operating
324 system, but not every package we want to make accessible is
325 <em>free</em> in our sense (see the Debian Free Software
326 Guidelines, below), or may be imported/exported without
327 restrictions. Thus, the archive is split into areas<footnote>
328 The Debian archive software uses the term "component" internally
329 and in the Release file format to refer to the division of an
330 archive. The Debian Social Contract simply refers to "areas."
331 This document uses terminology similar to the Social Contract.
332 </footnote> based on their licenses and other restrictions.
333 </p>
336 The aims of this are:
338 <list compact="compact">
339 <item>to allow us to make as much software available as we can</item>
340 <item>to allow us to encourage everyone to write free software,
341 and</item>
342 <item>to allow us to make it easy for people to produce
343 CD-ROMs of our system without violating any licenses,
344 import/export restrictions, or any other laws.</item>
345 </list>
346 </p>
349 The <em>main</em> archive area forms the <em>Debian GNU/Linux
350 distribution</em>.
351 </p>
354 Packages in the other archive areas (<tt>contrib</tt>,
355 <tt>non-free</tt>) are not considered to be part of the Debian
356 distribution, although we support their use and provide
357 infrastructure for them (such as our bug-tracking system and
358 mailing lists). This Debian Policy Manual applies to these
359 packages as well.
360 </p>
362 <sect id="dfsg">
363 <heading>The Debian Free Software Guidelines</heading>
365 The Debian Free Software Guidelines (DFSG) form our
366 definition of "free software". These are:
367 <taglist>
368 <tag>1. Free Redistribution
369 </tag>
370 <item>
371 The license of a Debian component may not restrict any
372 party from selling or giving away the software as a
373 component of an aggregate software distribution
374 containing programs from several different
375 sources. The license may not require a royalty or
376 other fee for such sale.
377 </item>
378 <tag>2. Source Code
379 </tag>
380 <item>
381 The program must include source code, and must allow
382 distribution in source code as well as compiled form.
383 </item>
384 <tag>3. Derived Works
385 </tag>
386 <item>
387 The license must allow modifications and derived
388 works, and must allow them to be distributed under the
389 same terms as the license of the original software.
390 </item>
391 <tag>4. Integrity of The Author's Source Code
392 </tag>
393 <item>
394 The license may restrict source-code from being
395 distributed in modified form <em>only</em> if the
396 license allows the distribution of "patch files"
397 with the source code for the purpose of modifying the
398 program at build time. The license must explicitly
399 permit distribution of software built from modified
400 source code. The license may require derived works to
401 carry a different name or version number from the
402 original software. (This is a compromise. The Debian
403 Project encourages all authors to not restrict any
404 files, source or binary, from being modified.)
405 </item>
406 <tag>5. No Discrimination Against Persons or Groups
407 </tag>
408 <item>
409 The license must not discriminate against any person
410 or group of persons.
411 </item>
412 <tag>6. No Discrimination Against Fields of Endeavor
413 </tag>
414 <item>
415 The license must not restrict anyone from making use
416 of the program in a specific field of endeavor. For
417 example, it may not restrict the program from being
418 used in a business, or from being used for genetic
419 research.
420 </item>
421 <tag>7. Distribution of License
422 </tag>
423 <item>
424 The rights attached to the program must apply to all
425 to whom the program is redistributed without the need
426 for execution of an additional license by those
427 parties.
428 </item>
429 <tag>8. License Must Not Be Specific to Debian
430 </tag>
431 <item>
432 The rights attached to the program must not depend on
433 the program's being part of a Debian system. If the
434 program is extracted from Debian and used or
435 distributed without Debian but otherwise within the
436 terms of the program's license, all parties to whom
437 the program is redistributed must have the same
438 rights as those that are granted in conjunction with
439 the Debian system.
440 </item>
441 <tag>9. License Must Not Contaminate Other Software
442 </tag>
443 <item>
444 The license must not place restrictions on other
445 software that is distributed along with the licensed
446 software. For example, the license must not insist
447 that all other programs distributed on the same medium
448 must be free software.
449 </item>
450 <tag>10. Example Licenses
451 </tag>
452 <item>
453 The "GPL," "BSD," and "Artistic" licenses are examples of
454 licenses that we consider <em>free</em>.
455 </item>
456 </taglist>
457 </p>
458 </sect>
460 <sect id="sections">
461 <heading>Archive areas</heading>
463 <sect1 id="main">
464 <heading>The main archive area</heading>
467 Every package in <em>main</em> must comply with the DFSG
468 (Debian Free Software Guidelines).
469 </p>
472 In addition, the packages in <em>main</em>
473 <list compact="compact">
474 <item>
475 must not require a package outside of <em>main</em>
476 for compilation or execution (thus, the package must
477 not declare a "Depends", "Recommends", or
478 "Build-Depends" relationship on a non-<em>main</em>
479 package),
480 </item>
481 <item>
482 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
484 </item>
485 <item>
486 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
487 manual.
488 </item>
489 </list>
490 </p>
492 </sect1>
494 <sect1 id="contrib">
495 <heading>The contrib archive area</heading>
498 Every package in <em>contrib</em> must comply with the DFSG.
499 </p>
502 In addition, the packages in <em>contrib</em>
503 <list compact="compact">
504 <item>
505 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
507 </item>
508 <item>
509 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
510 manual.
511 </item>
512 </list>
513 </p>
517 Examples of packages which would be included in
518 <em>contrib</em> are:
519 <list compact="compact">
520 <item>
521 free packages which require <em>contrib</em>,
522 <em>non-free</em> packages or packages which are not
523 in our archive at all for compilation or execution,
525 </item>
526 <item>
527 wrapper packages or other sorts of free accessories for
528 non-free programs.
529 </item>
530 </list>
531 </p>
532 </sect1>
534 <sect1 id="non-free">
535 <heading>The non-free archive area</heading>
538 Packages must be placed in <em>non-free</em> if they are
539 not compliant with the DFSG or are encumbered by patents
540 or other legal issues that make their distribution
541 problematic.
542 </p>
545 In addition, the packages in <em>non-free</em>
546 <list compact="compact">
547 <item>
548 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
550 </item>
551 <item>
552 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
553 manual that it is possible for them to meet.
554 <footnote>
555 It is possible that there are policy
556 requirements which the package is unable to
557 meet, for example, if the source is
558 unavailable. These situations will need to be
559 handled on a case-by-case basis.
560 </footnote>
561 </item>
562 </list>
563 </p>
564 </sect1>
566 </sect>
568 <sect id="pkgcopyright">
569 <heading>Copyright considerations</heading>
572 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
573 copyright information and distribution license in the file
574 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
575 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details).
576 </p>
579 We reserve the right to restrict files from being included
580 anywhere in our archives if
581 <list compact="compact">
582 <item>
583 their use or distribution would break a law,
584 </item>
585 <item>
586 there is an ethical conflict in their distribution or
587 use,
588 </item>
589 <item>
590 we would have to sign a license for them, or
591 </item>
592 <item>
593 their distribution would conflict with other project
594 policies.
595 </item>
596 </list>
597 </p>
600 Programs whose authors encourage the user to make
601 donations are fine for the main distribution, provided
602 that the authors do not claim that not donating is
603 immoral, unethical, illegal or something similar; in such
604 a case they must go in <em>non-free</em>.
605 </p>
608 Packages whose copyright permission notices (or patent
609 problems) do not even allow redistribution of binaries
610 only, and where no special permission has been obtained,
611 must not be placed on the Debian FTP site and its mirrors
612 at all.
613 </p>
616 Note that under international copyright law (this applies
617 in the United States, too), <em>no</em> distribution or
618 modification of a work is allowed without an explicit
619 notice saying so. Therefore a program without a copyright
620 notice <em>is</em> copyrighted and you may not do anything
621 to it without risking being sued! Likewise if a program
622 has a copyright notice but no statement saying what is
623 permitted then nothing is permitted.
624 </p>
627 Many authors are unaware of the problems that restrictive
628 copyrights (or lack of copyright notices) can cause for
629 the users of their supposedly-free software. It is often
630 worthwhile contacting such authors diplomatically to ask
631 them to modify their license terms. However, this can be a
632 politically difficult thing to do and you should ask for
633 advice on the <tt>debian-legal</tt> mailing list first, as
634 explained below.
635 </p>
638 When in doubt about a copyright, send mail to
639 <email>debian-legal@lists.debian.org</email>. Be prepared
640 to provide us with the copyright statement. Software
641 covered by the GPL, public domain software and BSD-like
642 copyrights are safe; be wary of the phrases "commercial
643 use prohibited" and "distribution restricted".
644 </p>
645 </sect>
647 <sect id="subsections">
648 <heading>Sections</heading>
651 The packages in the archive areas <em>main</em>,
652 <em>contrib</em> and <em>non-free</em> are grouped further into
653 <em>sections</em> to simplify handling.
654 </p>
657 The archive area and section for each package should be
658 specified in the package's <tt>Section</tt> control record (see
659 <ref id="f-Section">). However, the maintainer of the Debian
660 archive may override this selection to ensure the consistency of
661 the Debian distribution. The <tt>Section</tt> field should be
662 of the form:
663 <list compact="compact">
664 <item>
665 <em>section</em> if the package is in the
666 <em>main</em> archive area,
667 </item>
668 <item>
669 <em>area/section</em> if the package is in
670 the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em>
671 archive areas.
672 </item>
673 </list>
674 </p>
677 The Debian archive maintainers provide the authoritative
678 list of sections. At present, they are:
679 <em>admin</em>, <em>cli-mono</em>, <em>comm</em>, <em>database</em>,
680 <em>devel</em>, <em>debug</em>, <em>doc</em>, <em>editors</em>,
681 <em>electronics</em>, <em>embedded</em>, <em>fonts</em>,
682 <em>games</em>, <em>gnome</em>, <em>graphics</em>, <em>gnu-r</em>,
683 <em>gnustep</em>, <em>hamradio</em>, <em>haskell</em>,
684 <em>httpd</em>, <em>interpreters</em>, <em>java</em>, <em>kde</em>,
685 <em>kernel</em>, <em>libs</em>, <em>libdevel</em>, <em>lisp</em>,
686 <em>localization</em>, <em>mail</em>, <em>math</em>, <em>misc</em>,
687 <em>net</em>, <em>news</em>, <em>ocaml</em>, <em>oldlibs</em>,
688 <em>otherosfs</em>, <em>perl</em>, <em>php</em>, <em>python</em>,
689 <em>ruby</em>, <em>science</em>, <em>shells</em>, <em>sound</em>,
690 <em>tex</em>, <em>text</em>, <em>utils</em>, <em>vcs</em>,
691 <em>video</em>, <em>web</em>, <em>x11</em>, <em>xfce</em>,
692 <em>zope</em>. The additional section <em>debian-installer</em>
693 contains special packages used by the installer and is not used
694 for normal Debian packages.
695 </p>
698 For more information about the sections and their definitions,
699 see the <url id="http://packages.debian.org/unstable/"
700 name="list of sections in unstable">.
701 </p>
702 </sect>
704 <sect id="priorities">
705 <heading>Priorities</heading>
708 Each package should have a <em>priority</em> value, which is
709 included in the package's <em>control record</em>
710 (see <ref id="f-Priority">).
711 This information is used by the Debian package management tools to
712 separate high-priority packages from less-important packages.
713 </p>
716 The following <em>priority levels</em> are recognized by the
717 Debian package management tools.
718 <taglist>
719 <tag><tt>required</tt></tag>
720 <item>
721 Packages which are necessary for the proper
722 functioning of the system (usually, this means that
723 dpkg functionality depends on these packages).
724 Removing a <tt>required</tt> package may cause your
725 system to become totally broken and you may not even
726 be able to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to put things back,
727 so only do so if you know what you are doing. Systems
728 with only the <tt>required</tt> packages are probably
729 unusable, but they do have enough functionality to
730 allow the sysadmin to boot and install more software.
731 </item>
732 <tag><tt>important</tt></tag>
733 <item>
734 Important programs, including those which one would
735 expect to find on any Unix-like system. If the
736 expectation is that an experienced Unix person who
737 found it missing would say "What on earth is going on,
738 where is <prgn>foo</prgn>?", it must be an
739 <tt>important</tt> package.<footnote>
740 This is an important criterion because we are
741 trying to produce, amongst other things, a free
742 Unix.
743 </footnote>
744 Other packages without which the system will not run
745 well or be usable must also have priority
746 <tt>important</tt>. This does
747 <em>not</em> include Emacs, the X Window System, TeX
748 or any other large applications. The
749 <tt>important</tt> packages are just a bare minimum of
750 commonly-expected and necessary tools.
751 </item>
752 <tag><tt>standard</tt></tag>
753 <item>
754 These packages provide a reasonably small but not too
755 limited character-mode system. This is what will be
756 installed by default if the user doesn't select anything
757 else. It doesn't include many large applications.
758 </item>
759 <tag><tt>optional</tt></tag>
760 <item>
761 (In a sense everything that isn't required is
762 optional, but that's not what is meant here.) This is
763 all the software that you might reasonably want to
764 install if you didn't know what it was and don't have
765 specialized requirements. This is a much larger system
766 and includes the X Window System, a full TeX
767 distribution, and many applications. Note that
768 optional packages should not conflict with each other.
769 </item>
770 <tag><tt>extra</tt></tag>
771 <item>
772 This contains all packages that conflict with others
773 with required, important, standard or optional
774 priorities, or are only likely to be useful if you
775 already know what they are or have specialized
776 requirements (such as packages containing only detached
777 debugging symbols).
778 </item>
779 </taglist>
780 </p>
783 Packages must not depend on packages with lower priority
784 values (excluding build-time dependencies). In order to
785 ensure this, the priorities of one or more packages may need
786 to be adjusted.
787 </p>
788 </sect>
790 </chapt>
793 <chapt id="binary">
794 <heading>Binary packages</heading>
797 The Debian GNU/Linux distribution is based on the Debian
798 package management system, called <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Thus,
799 all packages in the Debian distribution must be provided
800 in the <tt>.deb</tt> file format.
801 </p>
803 <sect>
804 <heading>The package name</heading>
807 Every package must have a name that's unique within the Debian
808 archive.
809 </p>
812 The package name is included in the control field
813 <tt>Package</tt>, the format of which is described
814 in <ref id="f-Package">.
815 The package name is also included as a part of the file name
816 of the <tt>.deb</tt> file.
817 </p>
818 </sect>
820 <sect id="versions">
821 <heading>The version of a package</heading>
824 Every package has a version number recorded in its
825 <tt>Version</tt> control file field, described in
826 <ref id="f-Version">.
827 </p>
830 The package management system imposes an ordering on version
831 numbers, so that it can tell whether packages are being up- or
832 downgraded and so that package system front end applications
833 can tell whether a package it finds available is newer than
834 the one installed on the system. The version number format
835 has the most significant parts (as far as comparison is
836 concerned) at the beginning.
837 </p>
840 If an upstream package has problematic version numbers they
841 should be converted to a sane form for use in the
842 <tt>Version</tt> field.
843 </p>
845 <sect1>
846 <heading>Version numbers based on dates</heading>
849 In general, Debian packages should use the same version
850 numbers as the upstream sources.
851 </p>
854 However, in some cases where the upstream version number is
855 based on a date (e.g., a development "snapshot" release) the
856 package management system cannot handle these version
857 numbers without epochs. For example, dpkg will consider
858 "96May01" to be greater than "96Dec24".
859 </p>
862 To prevent having to use epochs for every new upstream
863 version, the date based portion of the version number
864 should be changed to the following format in such cases:
865 "19960501", "19961224". It is up to the maintainer whether
866 they want to bother the upstream maintainer to change
867 the version numbers upstream, too.
868 </p>
871 Note that other version formats based on dates which are
872 parsed correctly by the package management system should
873 <em>not</em> be changed.
874 </p>
877 Native Debian packages (i.e., packages which have been
878 written especially for Debian) whose version numbers include
879 dates should always use the "YYYYMMDD" format.
880 </p>
881 </sect1>
883 </sect>
885 <sect>
886 <heading>The maintainer of a package</heading>
889 Every package must have a Debian maintainer (the
890 maintainer may be one person or a group of people
891 reachable from a common email address, such as a mailing
892 list). The maintainer is responsible for ensuring that
893 the package is placed in the appropriate distributions.
894 </p>
897 The maintainer must be specified in the
898 <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field with their correct name
899 and a working email address. If one person maintains
900 several packages, they should try to avoid having
901 different forms of their name and email address in
902 the <tt>Maintainer</tt> fields of those packages.
903 </p>
906 The format of the <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field is
907 described in <ref id="f-Maintainer">.
908 </p>
911 If the maintainer of a package quits from the Debian
912 project, "Debian QA Group"
913 <email>packages@qa.debian.org</email> takes over the
914 maintainer-ship of the package until someone else
915 volunteers for that task. These packages are called
916 <em>orphaned packages</em>.<footnote>
917 The detailed procedure for doing this gracefully can
918 be found in the Debian Developer's Reference,
919 see <ref id="related">.
920 </footnote>
921 </p>
922 </sect>
924 <sect id="descriptions">
925 <heading>The description of a package</heading>
928 Every Debian package must have an extended description
929 stored in the appropriate field of the control record.
930 The technical information about the format of the
931 <tt>Description</tt> field is in <ref id="f-Description">.
932 </p>
935 The description should describe the package (the program) to a
936 user (system administrator) who has never met it before so that
937 they have enough information to decide whether they want to
938 install it. This description should not just be copied verbatim
939 from the program's documentation.
940 </p>
943 Put important information first, both in the synopsis and
944 extended description. Sometimes only the first part of the
945 synopsis or of the description will be displayed. You can
946 assume that there will usually be a way to see the whole
947 extended description.
948 </p>
951 The description should also give information about the
952 significant dependencies and conflicts between this package
953 and others, so that the user knows why these dependencies and
954 conflicts have been declared.
955 </p>
958 Instructions for configuring or using the package should
959 not be included (that is what installation scripts,
960 manual pages, info files, etc., are for). Copyright
961 statements and other administrivia should not be included
962 either (that is what the copyright file is for).
963 </p>
965 <sect1 id="synopsis"><heading>The single line synopsis</heading>
968 The single line synopsis should be kept brief - certainly
969 under 80 characters.
970 </p>
973 Do not include the package name in the synopsis line. The
974 display software knows how to display this already, and you
975 do not need to state it. Remember that in many situations
976 the user may only see the synopsis line - make it as
977 informative as you can.
978 </p>
980 </sect1>
982 <sect1 id="extendeddesc"><heading>The extended description</heading>
985 Do not try to continue the single line synopsis into the
986 extended description. This will not work correctly when
987 the full description is displayed, and makes no sense
988 where only the summary (the single line synopsis) is
989 available.
990 </p>
993 The extended description should describe what the package
994 does and how it relates to the rest of the system (in terms
995 of, for example, which subsystem it is which part of).
996 </p>
999 The description field needs to make sense to anyone, even
1000 people who have no idea about any of the things the
1001 package deals with.<footnote>
1002 The blurb that comes with a program in its
1003 announcements and/or <prgn>README</prgn> files is
1004 rarely suitable for use in a description. It is
1005 usually aimed at people who are already in the
1006 community where the package is used.
1007 </footnote>
1008 </p>
1010 </sect1>
1012 </sect>
1014 <sect>
1015 <heading>Dependencies</heading>
1018 Every package must specify the dependency information
1019 about other packages that are required for the first to
1020 work correctly.
1021 </p>
1024 For example, a dependency entry must be provided for any
1025 shared libraries required by a dynamically-linked executable
1026 binary in a package.
1027 </p>
1030 Packages are not required to declare any dependencies they
1031 have on other packages which are marked <tt>Essential</tt>
1032 (see below), and should not do so unless they depend on a
1033 particular version of that package.<footnote>
1035 Essential is needed in part to avoid unresolvable dependency
1036 loops on upgrade. If packages add unnecessary dependencies
1037 on packages in this set, the chances that there
1038 <strong>will</strong> be an unresolvable dependency loop
1039 caused by forcing these Essential packages to be configured
1040 first before they need to be is greatly increased. It also
1041 increases the chances that frontends will be unable to
1042 <strong>calculate</strong> an upgrade path, even if one
1043 exists.
1044 </p>
1046 Also, functionality is rarely ever removed from the
1047 Essential set, but <em>packages</em> have been removed from
1048 the Essential set when the functionality moved to a
1049 different package. So depending on these packages <em>just
1050 in case</em> they stop being essential does way more harm
1051 than good.
1052 </p>
1053 </footnote>
1054 </p>
1057 Sometimes, a package requires another package to be installed
1058 <em>and</em> configured before it can be installed. In this
1059 case, you must specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for
1060 the package.
1061 </p>
1064 You should not specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for a
1065 package before this has been discussed on the
1066 <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and a consensus about
1067 doing that has been reached.
1068 </p>
1071 The format of the package interrelationship control fields is
1072 described in <ref id="relationships">.
1073 </p>
1074 </sect>
1076 <sect id="virtual_pkg">
1077 <heading>Virtual packages</heading>
1080 Sometimes, there are several packages which offer
1081 more-or-less the same functionality. In this case, it's
1082 useful to define a <em>virtual package</em> whose name
1083 describes that common functionality. (The virtual
1084 packages only exist logically, not physically; that's why
1085 they are called <em>virtual</em>.) The packages with this
1086 particular function will then <em>provide</em> the virtual
1087 package. Thus, any other package requiring that function
1088 can simply depend on the virtual package without having to
1089 specify all possible packages individually.
1090 </p>
1093 All packages should use virtual package names where
1094 appropriate, and arrange to create new ones if necessary.
1095 They should not use virtual package names (except privately,
1096 amongst a cooperating group of packages) unless they have
1097 been agreed upon and appear in the list of virtual package
1098 names. (See also <ref id="virtual">)
1099 </p>
1102 The latest version of the authoritative list of virtual
1103 package names can be found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
1104 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1105 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"
1106 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"></tt>.
1107 </p>
1110 The procedure for updating the list is described in the preface
1111 to the list.
1112 </p>
1114 </sect>
1116 <sect>
1117 <heading>Base system</heading>
1120 The <tt>base system</tt> is a minimum subset of the Debian
1121 GNU/Linux system that is installed before everything else
1122 on a new system. Only very few packages are allowed to form
1123 part of the base system, in order to keep the required disk
1124 usage very small.
1125 </p>
1128 The base system consists of all those packages with priority
1129 <tt>required</tt> or <tt>important</tt>. Many of them will
1130 be tagged <tt>essential</tt> (see below).
1131 </p>
1132 </sect>
1134 <sect>
1135 <heading>Essential packages</heading>
1138 Essential is defined as the minimal set of functionality that
1139 must be available and usable on the system at all times, even
1140 when packages are in an unconfigured (but unpacked) state.
1141 Packages are tagged <tt>essential</tt> for a system using the
1142 <tt>Essential</tt> control file field. The format of the
1143 <tt>Essential</tt> control field is described in <ref
1144 id="f-Essential">.
1145 </p>
1148 Since these packages cannot be easily removed (one has to
1149 specify an extra <em>force option</em> to
1150 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to do so), this flag must not be used
1151 unless absolutely necessary. A shared library package
1152 must not be tagged <tt>essential</tt>; dependencies will
1153 prevent its premature removal, and we need to be able to
1154 remove it when it has been superseded.
1155 </p>
1158 Since dpkg will not prevent upgrading of other packages
1159 while an <tt>essential</tt> package is in an unconfigured
1160 state, all <tt>essential</tt> packages must supply all of
1161 their core functionality even when unconfigured. If the
1162 package cannot satisfy this requirement it must not be
1163 tagged as essential, and any packages depending on this
1164 package must instead have explicit dependency fields as
1165 appropriate.
1166 </p>
1169 Maintainers should take great care in adding any programs,
1170 interfaces, or functionality to <tt>essential</tt> packages.
1171 Packages may assume that functionality provided by
1172 <tt>essential</tt> packages is always available without
1173 declaring explicit dependencies, which means that removing
1174 functionality from the Essential set is very difficult and is
1175 almost never done. Any capability added to an
1176 <tt>essential</tt> package therefore creates an obligation to
1177 support that capability as part of the Essential set in
1178 perpetuity.
1179 </p>
1182 You must not tag any packages <tt>essential</tt> before
1183 this has been discussed on the <tt>debian-devel</tt>
1184 mailing list and a consensus about doing that has been
1185 reached.
1186 </p>
1187 </sect>
1189 <sect id="maintscripts">
1190 <heading>Maintainer Scripts</heading>
1193 The package installation scripts should avoid producing
1194 output which is unnecessary for the user to see and
1195 should rely on <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to stave off boredom on
1196 the part of a user installing many packages. This means,
1197 amongst other things, using the <tt>--quiet</tt> option on
1198 <prgn>install-info</prgn>.
1199 </p>
1202 Errors which occur during the execution of an installation
1203 script must be checked and the installation must not
1204 continue after an error.
1205 </p>
1208 Note that in general <ref id="scripts"> applies to package
1209 maintainer scripts, too.
1210 </p>
1213 You should not use <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> on a file
1214 belonging to another package without consulting the
1215 maintainer of that package first.
1216 </p>
1219 All packages which supply an instance of a common command
1220 name (or, in general, filename) should generally use
1221 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>, so that they may be
1222 installed together. If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>
1223 is not used, then each package must use
1224 <tt>Conflicts</tt> to ensure that other packages are
1225 de-installed. (In this case, it may be appropriate to
1226 specify a conflict against earlier versions of something
1227 that previously did not use
1228 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>; this is an exception to
1229 the usual rule that versioned conflicts should be
1230 avoided.)
1231 </p>
1233 <sect1 id="maintscriptprompt">
1234 <heading>Prompting in maintainer scripts</heading>
1236 Package maintainer scripts may prompt the user if
1237 necessary. Prompting must be done by communicating
1238 through a program, such as <prgn>debconf</prgn>, which
1239 conforms to the Debian Configuration Management
1240 Specification, version 2 or higher.
1241 </p>
1244 Packages which are essential, or which are dependencies of
1245 essential packages, may fall back on another prompting method
1246 if no such interface is available when they are executed.
1247 </p>
1250 The Debian Configuration Management Specification is included
1251 in the <file>debconf_specification</file> files in the
1252 <package>debian-policy</package> package.
1253 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1254 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"
1255 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"></tt>.
1256 </p>
1259 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1260 Specification may contain an additional
1261 <prgn>config</prgn> script and a <tt>templates</tt>
1262 file in their control archive<footnote>
1263 The control.tar.gz inside the .deb.
1264 See <manref name="deb" section="5">.
1265 </footnote>.
1266 The <prgn>config</prgn> script might be run before the
1267 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script, and before the package is unpacked
1268 or any of its dependencies or pre-dependencies are satisfied.
1269 Therefore it must work using only the tools present in
1270 <em>essential</em> packages.<footnote>
1271 <package>Debconf</package> or another tool that
1272 implements the Debian Configuration Management
1273 Specification will also be installed, and any
1274 versioned dependencies on it will be satisfied
1275 before preconfiguration begins.
1276 </footnote>
1277 </p>
1280 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1281 Specification must allow for translation of their user-visible
1282 messages by using a gettext-based system such as the one
1283 provided by the <package>po-debconf</package> package.
1284 </p>
1287 Packages should try to minimize the amount of prompting
1288 they need to do, and they should ensure that the user
1289 will only ever be asked each question once. This means
1290 that packages should try to use appropriate shared
1291 configuration files (such as <file>/etc/papersize</file> and
1292 <file>/etc/news/server</file>), and shared
1293 <package>debconf</package> variables rather than each
1294 prompting for their own list of required pieces of
1295 information.
1296 </p>
1299 It also means that an upgrade should not ask the same
1300 questions again, unless the user has used
1301 <tt>dpkg --purge</tt> to remove the package's configuration.
1302 The answers to configuration questions should be stored in an
1303 appropriate place in <file>/etc</file> so that the user can
1304 modify them, and how this has been done should be
1305 documented.
1306 </p>
1309 If a package has a vitally important piece of
1310 information to pass to the user (such as "don't run me
1311 as I am, you must edit the following configuration files
1312 first or you risk your system emitting badly-formatted
1313 messages"), it should display this in the
1314 <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn> script and
1315 prompt the user to hit return to acknowledge the
1316 message. Copyright messages do not count as vitally
1317 important (they belong in
1318 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>);
1319 neither do instructions on how to use a program (these
1320 should be in on-line documentation, where all the users
1321 can see them).
1322 </p>
1325 Any necessary prompting should almost always be confined
1326 to the <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>
1327 script. If it is done in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>, it
1328 should be protected with a conditional so that
1329 unnecessary prompting doesn't happen if a package's
1330 installation fails and the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is
1331 called with <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>,
1332 <tt>abort-remove</tt> or <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt>.
1333 </p>
1334 </sect1>
1336 </sect>
1338 </chapt>
1341 <chapt id="source">
1342 <heading>Source packages</heading>
1344 <sect id="standardsversion">
1345 <heading>Standards conformance</heading>
1348 Source packages should specify the most recent version number
1349 of this policy document with which your package complied
1350 when it was last updated.
1351 </p>
1354 This information may be used to file bug reports
1355 automatically if your package becomes too much out of date.
1356 </p>
1359 The version is specified in the <tt>Standards-Version</tt>
1360 control field.
1361 The format of the <tt>Standards-Version</tt> field is
1362 described in <ref id="f-Standards-Version">.
1363 </p>
1366 You should regularly, and especially if your package has
1367 become out of date, check for the newest Policy Manual
1368 available and update your package, if necessary. When your
1369 package complies with the new standards you should update the
1370 <tt>Standards-Version</tt> source package field and
1371 release it.<footnote>
1372 See the file <file>upgrading-checklist</file> for
1373 information about policy which has changed between
1374 different versions of this document.
1375 </footnote>
1376 </p>
1378 </sect>
1380 <sect id="pkg-relations">
1381 <heading>Package relationships</heading>
1384 Source packages should specify which binary packages they
1385 require to be installed or not to be installed in order to
1386 build correctly. For example, if building a package
1387 requires a certain compiler, then the compiler should be
1388 specified as a build-time dependency.
1389 </p>
1392 It is not necessary to explicitly specify build-time
1393 relationships on a minimal set of packages that are always
1394 needed to compile, link and put in a Debian package a
1395 standard "Hello World!" program written in C or C++. The
1396 required packages are called <em>build-essential</em>, and
1397 an informational list can be found in
1398 <file>/usr/share/doc/build-essential/list</file> (which is
1399 contained in the <tt>build-essential</tt>
1400 package).<footnote>
1401 Rationale:
1402 <list compact="compact">
1403 <item>
1404 This allows maintaining the list separately
1405 from the policy documents (the list does not
1406 need the kind of control that the policy
1407 documents do).
1408 </item>
1409 <item>
1410 Having a separate package allows one to install
1411 the build-essential packages on a machine, as
1412 well as allowing other packages such as tasks to
1413 require installation of the build-essential
1414 packages using the depends relation.
1415 </item>
1416 <item>
1417 The separate package allows bug reports against
1418 the list to be categorized separately from
1419 the policy management process in the BTS.
1420 </item>
1421 </list>
1422 </footnote>
1423 </p>
1426 When specifying the set of build-time dependencies, one
1427 should list only those packages explicitly required by the
1428 build. It is not necessary to list packages which are
1429 required merely because some other package in the list of
1430 build-time dependencies depends on them.<footnote>
1431 The reason for this is that dependencies change, and
1432 you should list all those packages, and <em>only</em>
1433 those packages that <em>you</em> need directly. What
1434 others need is their business. For example, if you
1435 only link against <file>libimlib</file>, you will need to
1436 build-depend on <package>libimlib2-dev</package> but
1437 not against any <tt>libjpeg*</tt> packages, even
1438 though <tt>libimlib2-dev</tt> currently depends on
1439 them: installation of <package>libimlib2-dev</package>
1440 will automatically ensure that all of its run-time
1441 dependencies are satisfied.
1442 </footnote>
1443 </p>
1446 If build-time dependencies are specified, it must be
1447 possible to build the package and produce working binaries
1448 on a system with only essential and build-essential
1449 packages installed and also those required to satisfy the
1450 build-time relationships (including any implied
1451 relationships). In particular, this means that version
1452 clauses should be used rigorously in build-time
1453 relationships so that one cannot produce bad or
1454 inconsistently configured packages when the relationships
1455 are properly satisfied.
1456 </p>
1459 <ref id="relationships"> explains the technical details.
1460 </p>
1461 </sect>
1463 <sect>
1464 <heading>Changes to the upstream sources</heading>
1467 If changes to the source code are made that are not
1468 specific to the needs of the Debian system, they should be
1469 sent to the upstream authors in whatever form they prefer
1470 so as to be included in the upstream version of the
1471 package.
1472 </p>
1475 If you need to configure the package differently for
1476 Debian or for Linux, and the upstream source doesn't
1477 provide a way to do so, you should add such configuration
1478 facilities (for example, a new <prgn>autoconf</prgn> test
1479 or <tt>#define</tt>) and send the patch to the upstream
1480 authors, with the default set to the way they originally
1481 had it. You can then easily override the default in your
1482 <file>debian/rules</file> or wherever is appropriate.
1483 </p>
1486 You should make sure that the <prgn>configure</prgn> utility
1487 detects the correct architecture specification string
1488 (refer to <ref id="arch-spec"> for details).
1489 </p>
1492 If you need to edit a <prgn>Makefile</prgn> where GNU-style
1493 <prgn>configure</prgn> scripts are used, you should edit the
1494 <file>.in</file> files rather than editing the
1495 <prgn>Makefile</prgn> directly. This allows the user to
1496 reconfigure the package if necessary. You should
1497 <em>not</em> configure the package and edit the generated
1498 <prgn>Makefile</prgn>! This makes it impossible for someone
1499 else to later reconfigure the package without losing the
1500 changes you made.
1501 </p>
1503 </sect>
1505 <sect id="dpkgchangelog">
1506 <heading>Debian changelog: <file>debian/changelog</file></heading>
1509 Changes in the Debian version of the package should be
1510 briefly explained in the Debian changelog file
1511 <file>debian/changelog</file>.<footnote>
1513 Mistakes in changelogs are usually best rectified by
1514 making a new changelog entry rather than "rewriting
1515 history" by editing old changelog entries.
1516 </p>
1517 </footnote>
1518 This includes modifications
1519 made in the Debian package compared to the upstream one
1520 as well as other changes and updates to the package.
1521 <footnote>
1522 Although there is nothing stopping an author who is also
1523 the Debian maintainer from using this changelog for all
1524 their changes, it will have to be renamed if the Debian
1525 and upstream maintainers become different people. In such
1526 a case, however, it might be better to maintain the package
1527 as a non-native package.
1528 </footnote>
1529 </p>
1532 The format of the <file>debian/changelog</file> allows the
1533 package building tools to discover which version of the package
1534 is being built and find out other release-specific information.
1535 </p>
1538 That format is a series of entries like this:
1540 <example compact="compact">
1541 <var>package</var> (<var>version</var>) <var>distribution(s)</var>; urgency=<var>urgency</var>
1542 <var>
1543 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1544 </var>
1545 * <var>change details</var>
1546 <var>more change details</var>
1547 <var>
1548 [blank line(s), included in output of dpkg-parsechangelog]
1549 </var>
1550 * <var>even more change details</var>
1551 <var>
1552 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1553 </var>
1554 -- <var>maintainer name</var> &lt;<var>email address</var>&gt;<var>[two spaces]</var> <var>date</var>
1555 </example>
1556 </p>
1559 <var>package</var> and <var>version</var> are the source
1560 package name and version number.
1561 </p>
1564 <var>distribution(s)</var> lists the distributions where
1565 this version should be installed when it is uploaded - it
1566 is copied to the <tt>Distribution</tt> field in the
1567 <file>.changes</file> file. See <ref id="f-Distribution">.
1568 </p>
1571 <var>urgency</var> is the value for the <tt>Urgency</tt>
1572 field in the <file>.changes</file> file for the upload
1573 (see <ref id="f-Urgency">). It is not possible to specify
1574 an urgency containing commas; commas are used to separate
1575 <tt><var>keyword</var>=<var>value</var></tt> settings in the
1576 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> changelog format (though there is
1577 currently only one useful <var>keyword</var>,
1578 <tt>urgency</tt>).
1579 </p>
1582 The change details may in fact be any series of lines
1583 starting with at least two spaces, but conventionally each
1584 change starts with an asterisk and a separating space and
1585 continuation lines are indented so as to bring them in
1586 line with the start of the text above. Blank lines may be
1587 used here to separate groups of changes, if desired.
1588 </p>
1591 If this upload resolves bugs recorded in the Bug Tracking
1592 System (BTS), they may be automatically closed on the
1593 inclusion of this package into the Debian archive by
1594 including the string: <tt>closes: Bug#<var>nnnnn</var></tt>
1595 in the change details.<footnote>
1596 To be precise, the string should match the following
1597 Perl regular expression:
1598 <example>
1599 /closes:\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+(?:,\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+)*/i
1600 </example>
1601 Then all of the bug numbers listed will be closed by the
1602 archive maintenance script (<prgn>katie</prgn>) using the
1603 <var>version</var> of the changelog entry.
1604 </footnote>
1605 This information is conveyed via the <tt>Closes</tt> field
1606 in the <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Closes">).
1607 </p>
1610 The maintainer name and email address used in the changelog
1611 should be the details of the person uploading <em>this</em>
1612 version. They are <em>not</em> necessarily those of the
1613 usual package maintainer. The information here will be
1614 copied to the <tt>Changed-By</tt> field in the
1615 <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Changed-By">),
1616 and then later used to send an acknowledgement when the
1617 upload has been installed.
1618 </p>
1621 The <var>date</var> has the following format<footnote>
1622 This is the same as the format generated by <tt>date
1623 -R</tt>.
1624 </footnote> (compatible and with the same semantics of
1625 RFC 2822 and RFC 5322):
1626 <example>day-of-week, dd month yyyy hh:mm:ss +zzzz</example>
1627 where:
1628 <list compact="compact">
1629 <item>
1630 day-of week is one of: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun
1631 </item>
1632 <item>
1633 dd is a one- or two-digit day of the month (01-31)
1634 </item>
1635 <item>
1636 month is one of: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug,
1637 Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec
1638 </item>
1639 <item>yyyy is the four-digit year (e.g. 2010)</item>
1640 <item>hh is the two-digit hour (00-23)</item>
1641 <item>mm is the two-digit minutes (00-59)</item>
1642 <item>ss is the two-digit seconds (00-60)</item>
1643 <item>
1644 +zzzz or -zzzz is the the time zone offset from Coordinated
1645 Universal Time (UTC). "+" indicates that the time is ahead
1646 of (i.e., east of) UTC and "-" indicates that the time is
1647 behind (i.e., west of) UTC. The first two digits indicate
1648 the hour difference from UTC and the last two digits
1649 indicate the number of additional minutes difference from
1650 UTC. The last two digits must be in the range 00-59.
1651 </item>
1652 </list>
1653 </p>
1656 The first "title" line with the package name must start
1657 at the left hand margin. The "trailer" line with the
1658 maintainer and date details must be preceded by exactly
1659 one space. The maintainer details and the date must be
1660 separated by exactly two spaces.
1661 </p>
1664 The entire changelog must be encoded in UTF-8.
1665 </p>
1668 For more information on placement of the changelog files
1669 within binary packages, please see <ref id="changelogs">.
1670 </p>
1671 </sect>
1673 <sect id="dpkgcopyright">
1674 <heading>Copyright: <file>debian/copyright</file></heading>
1676 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
1677 copyright information and distribution license in the file
1678 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
1679 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details). Also see
1680 <ref id="pkgcopyright"> for further considerations related
1681 to copyrights for packages.
1682 </p>
1683 </sect>
1684 <sect>
1685 <heading>Error trapping in makefiles</heading>
1688 When <prgn>make</prgn> invokes a command in a makefile
1689 (including your package's upstream makefiles and
1690 <file>debian/rules</file>), it does so using <prgn>sh</prgn>. This
1691 means that <prgn>sh</prgn>'s usual bad error handling
1692 properties apply: if you include a miniature script as one
1693 of the commands in your makefile you'll find that if you
1694 don't do anything about it then errors are not detected
1695 and <prgn>make</prgn> will blithely continue after
1696 problems.
1697 </p>
1700 Every time you put more than one shell command (this
1701 includes using a loop) in a makefile command you
1702 must make sure that errors are trapped. For
1703 simple compound commands, such as changing directory and
1704 then running a program, using <tt>&amp;&amp;</tt> rather
1705 than semicolon as a command separator is sufficient. For
1706 more complex commands including most loops and
1707 conditionals you should include a separate <tt>set -e</tt>
1708 command at the start of every makefile command that's
1709 actually one of these miniature shell scripts.
1710 </p>
1711 </sect>
1713 <sect id="timestamps">
1714 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
1716 Maintainers should preserve the modification times of the
1717 upstream source files in a package, as far as is reasonably
1718 possible.<footnote>
1719 The rationale is that there is some information conveyed
1720 by knowing the age of the file, for example, you could
1721 recognize that some documentation is very old by looking
1722 at the modification time, so it would be nice if the
1723 modification time of the upstream source would be
1724 preserved.
1725 </footnote>
1726 </p>
1727 </sect>
1729 <sect id="restrictions">
1730 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
1733 The source package may not contain any hard links<footnote>
1735 This is not currently detected when building source
1736 packages, but only when extracting
1737 them.
1738 </p>
1740 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
1741 future, but would require a fair amount of
1742 work.
1743 </p>
1744 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
1745 setgid files.<footnote>
1746 Setgid directories are allowed.
1747 </footnote>
1748 </p>
1749 </sect>
1751 <sect id="debianrules">
1752 <heading>Main building script: <file>debian/rules</file></heading>
1755 This file must be an executable makefile, and contains the
1756 package-specific recipes for compiling the package and
1757 building binary package(s) from the source.
1758 </p>
1761 It must start with the line <tt>#!/usr/bin/make -f</tt>,
1762 so that it can be invoked by saying its name rather than
1763 invoking <prgn>make</prgn> explicitly. That is, invoking
1764 either of <tt>make -f debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt>
1765 or <tt>./debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt> must result in
1766 identical behavior.
1767 </p>
1770 Since an interactive <file>debian/rules</file> script makes it
1771 impossible to auto-compile that package and also makes it
1772 hard for other people to reproduce the same binary
1773 package, all <em>required targets</em> must be
1774 non-interactive. At a minimum, required targets are the
1775 ones called by <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, namely,
1776 <em>clean</em>, <em>binary</em>, <em>binary-arch</em>,
1777 <em>binary-indep</em>, and <em>build</em>. It also follows
1778 that any target that these targets depend on must also be
1779 non-interactive.
1780 </p>
1783 The targets are as follows (required unless stated otherwise):
1784 <taglist>
1785 <tag><tt>build</tt></tag>
1786 <item>
1788 The <tt>build</tt> target should perform all the
1789 configuration and compilation of the package.
1790 If a package has an interactive pre-build
1791 configuration routine, the Debianized source package
1792 must either be built after this has taken place (so
1793 that the binary package can be built without rerunning
1794 the configuration) or the configuration routine
1795 modified to become non-interactive. (The latter is
1796 preferable if there are architecture-specific features
1797 detected by the configuration routine.)
1798 </p>
1801 For some packages, notably ones where the same
1802 source tree is compiled in different ways to produce
1803 two binary packages, the <tt>build</tt> target
1804 does not make much sense. For these packages it is
1805 good enough to provide two (or more) targets
1806 (<tt>build-a</tt> and <tt>build-b</tt> or whatever)
1807 for each of the ways of building the package, and a
1808 <tt>build</tt> target that does nothing. The
1809 <tt>binary</tt> target will have to build the
1810 package in each of the possible ways and make the
1811 binary package out of each.
1812 </p>
1815 The <tt>build</tt> target must not do anything
1816 that might require root privilege.
1817 </p>
1820 The <tt>build</tt> target may need to run the
1821 <tt>clean</tt> target first - see below.
1822 </p>
1825 When a package has a configuration and build routine
1826 which takes a long time, or when the makefiles are
1827 poorly designed, or when <tt>build</tt> needs to
1828 run <tt>clean</tt> first, it is a good idea to
1829 <tt>touch build</tt> when the build process is
1830 complete. This will ensure that if <tt>debian/rules
1831 build</tt> is run again it will not rebuild the whole
1832 program.<footnote>
1833 Another common way to do this is for <tt>build</tt>
1834 to depend on <prgn>build-stamp</prgn> and to do
1835 nothing else, and for the <prgn>build-stamp</prgn>
1836 target to do the building and to <tt>touch
1837 build-stamp</tt> on completion. This is
1838 especially useful if the build routine creates a
1839 file or directory called <tt>build</tt>; in such a
1840 case, <tt>build</tt> will need to be listed as
1841 a phony target (i.e., as a dependency of the
1842 <tt>.PHONY</tt> target). See the documentation of
1843 <prgn>make</prgn> for more information on phony
1844 targets.
1845 </footnote>
1846 </p>
1847 </item>
1849 <tag><tt>build-arch</tt> (optional),
1850 <tt>build-indep</tt> (optional)
1851 </tag>
1852 <item>
1854 A package may also provide both of the targets
1855 <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt>.
1856 The <tt>build-arch</tt> target, if provided, should
1857 perform all the configuration and compilation required
1858 for producing all architecture-dependant binary packages
1859 (those packages for which the body of the
1860 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt>
1861 is not <tt>all</tt>).
1862 Similarly, the <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
1863 provided, should perform all the configuration and
1864 compilation required for producing all
1865 architecture-independent binary packages
1866 (those packages for which the body of the
1867 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt>
1868 is <tt>all</tt>).
1869 The <tt>build</tt> target should depend on those of the
1870 targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> that
1871 are provided in the rules file.
1872 </p>
1875 If one or both of the targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and
1876 <tt>build-indep</tt> are not provided, then invoking
1877 <file>debian/rules</file> with one of the not-provided
1878 targets as arguments should produce a exit status code
1879 of 2. Usually this is provided automatically by make
1880 if the target is missing.
1881 </p>
1884 The <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> targets
1885 must not do anything that might require root privilege.
1886 </p>
1887 </item>
1889 <tag><tt>binary</tt>, <tt>binary-arch</tt>,
1890 <tt>binary-indep</tt>
1891 </tag>
1892 <item>
1894 The <tt>binary</tt> target must be all that is
1895 necessary for the user to build the binary package(s)
1896 produced from this source package. It is
1897 split into two parts: <prgn>binary-arch</prgn> builds
1898 the binary packages which are specific to a particular
1899 architecture, and <tt>binary-indep</tt> builds
1900 those which are not.
1901 </p>
1903 <tt>binary</tt> may be (and commonly is) a target with
1904 no commands which simply depends on
1905 <tt>binary-arch</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
1906 </p>
1908 Both <tt>binary-*</tt> targets should depend on the
1909 <tt>build</tt> target, or on the appropriate
1910 <tt>build-arch</tt> or <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
1911 provided, so that the package is built if it has not
1912 been already. It should then create the relevant
1913 binary package(s), using <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
1914 make their control files and <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> to
1915 build them and place them in the parent of the top
1916 level directory.
1917 </p>
1920 Both the <tt>binary-arch</tt> and
1921 <tt>binary-indep</tt> targets <em>must</em> exist.
1922 If one of them has nothing to do (which will always be
1923 the case if the source generates only a single binary
1924 package, whether architecture-dependent or not), it
1925 must still exist and must always succeed.
1926 </p>
1929 The <tt>binary</tt> targets must be invoked as
1930 root.<footnote>
1931 The <prgn>fakeroot</prgn> package often allows one
1932 to build a package correctly even without being
1933 root.
1934 </footnote>
1935 </p>
1936 </item>
1938 <tag><tt>clean</tt></tag>
1939 <item>
1941 This must undo any effects that the <tt>build</tt>
1942 and <tt>binary</tt> targets may have had, except
1943 that it should leave alone any output files created in
1944 the parent directory by a run of a <tt>binary</tt>
1945 target.
1946 </p>
1949 If a <tt>build</tt> file is touched at the end of
1950 the <tt>build</tt> target, as suggested above, it
1951 should be removed as the first action that
1952 <tt>clean</tt> performs, so that running
1953 <tt>build</tt> again after an interrupted
1954 <tt>clean</tt> doesn't think that everything is
1955 already done.
1956 </p>
1959 The <tt>clean</tt> target may need to be
1960 invoked as root if <tt>binary</tt> has been
1961 invoked since the last <tt>clean</tt>, or if
1962 <tt>build</tt> has been invoked as root (since
1963 <tt>build</tt> may create directories, for
1964 example).
1965 </p>
1966 </item>
1968 <tag><tt>get-orig-source</tt> (optional)</tag>
1969 <item>
1971 This target fetches the most recent version of the
1972 original source package from a canonical archive site
1973 (via FTP or WWW, for example), does any necessary
1974 rearrangement to turn it into the original source
1975 tar file format described below, and leaves it in the
1976 current directory.
1977 </p>
1980 This target may be invoked in any directory, and
1981 should take care to clean up any temporary files it
1982 may have left.
1983 </p>
1986 This target is optional, but providing it if
1987 possible is a good idea.
1988 </p>
1989 </item>
1991 <tag><tt>patch</tt> (optional)</tag>
1992 <item>
1994 This target performs whatever additional actions are
1995 required to make the source ready for editing (unpacking
1996 additional upstream archives, applying patches, etc.).
1997 It is recommended to be implemented for any package where
1998 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> does not result in source ready
1999 for additional modification. See
2000 <ref id="readmesource">.
2001 </p>
2002 </item>
2003 </taglist>
2006 The <tt>build</tt>, <tt>binary</tt> and
2007 <tt>clean</tt> targets must be invoked with the current
2008 directory being the package's top-level directory.
2009 </p>
2013 Additional targets may exist in <file>debian/rules</file>,
2014 either as published or undocumented interfaces or for the
2015 package's internal use.
2016 </p>
2019 The architectures we build on and build for are determined
2020 by <prgn>make</prgn> variables using the utility
2021 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-architecture"><prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn></qref>.
2022 You can determine the
2023 Debian architecture and the GNU style architecture
2024 specification string for the build machine (the machine type
2025 we are building on) as well as for the host machine (the
2026 machine type we are building for). Here is a list of
2027 supported <prgn>make</prgn> variables:
2028 <list compact="compact">
2029 <item>
2030 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt> (the Debian architecture)
2031 </item>
2032 <item>
2033 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> (the Debian CPU name)
2034 </item>
2035 <item>
2036 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> (the Debian System name)
2037 </item>
2038 <item>
2039 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt> (the GNU style architecture
2040 specification string)
2041 </item>
2042 <item>
2043 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_CPU</tt> (the CPU part of
2044 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2045 </item>
2046 <item>
2047 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_SYSTEM</tt> (the System part of
2048 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2049 </list>
2050 where <tt>*</tt> is either <tt>BUILD</tt> for specification of
2051 the build machine or <tt>HOST</tt> for specification of the
2052 host machine.
2053 </p>
2056 Backward compatibility can be provided in the rules file
2057 by setting the needed variables to suitable default
2058 values; please refer to the documentation of
2059 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> for details.
2060 </p>
2063 It is important to understand that the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt>
2064 string only determines which Debian architecture we are
2065 building on or for. It should not be used to get the CPU
2066 or system information; the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> and
2067 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> variables should be used for that.
2068 GNU style variables should generally only be used with upstream
2069 build systems.
2070 </p>
2072 <sect1 id="debianrules-options">
2073 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> and
2074 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt></heading>
2077 Supporting the standardized environment variable
2078 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> is recommended. This variable can
2079 contain several flags to change how a package is compiled and
2080 built. Each flag must be in the form <var>flag</var> or
2081 <var>flag</var>=<var>options</var>. If multiple flags are
2082 given, they must be separated by whitespace.<footnote>
2083 Some packages support any delimiter, but whitespace is the
2084 easiest to parse inside a makefile and avoids ambiguity with
2085 flag values that contain commas.
2086 </footnote>
2087 <var>flag</var> must start with a lowercase letter
2088 (<tt>a-z</tt>) and consist only of lowercase letters,
2089 numbers (<tt>0-9</tt>), and the characters
2090 <tt>-</tt> and <tt>_</tt> (hyphen and underscore).
2091 <var>options</var> must not contain whitespace. The same
2092 tag should not be given multiple times with conflicting
2093 values. Package maintainers may assume that
2094 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> will not contain conflicting tags.
2095 </p>
2098 The meaning of the following tags has been standardized:
2099 <taglist>
2100 <tag>nocheck</tag>
2101 <item>
2102 This tag says to not run any build-time test suite
2103 provided by the package.
2104 </item>
2105 <tag>noopt</tag>
2106 <item>
2107 The presence of this tag means that the package should
2108 be compiled with a minimum of optimization. For C
2109 programs, it is best to add <tt>-O0</tt> to
2110 <tt>CFLAGS</tt> (although this is usually the default).
2111 Some programs might fail to build or run at this level
2112 of optimization; it may be necessary to use
2113 <tt>-O1</tt>, for example.
2114 </item>
2115 <tag>nostrip</tag>
2116 <item>
2117 This tag means that the debugging symbols should not be
2118 stripped from the binary during installation, so that
2119 debugging information may be included in the package.
2120 </item>
2121 <tag>parallel=n</tag>
2122 <item>
2123 This tag means that the package should be built using up
2124 to <tt>n</tt> parallel processes if the package build
2125 system supports this.<footnote>
2126 Packages built with <tt>make</tt> can often implement
2127 this by passing the <tt>-j</tt><var>n</var> option to
2128 <tt>make</tt>.
2129 </footnote>
2130 If the package build system does not support parallel
2131 builds, this string must be ignored. If the package
2132 build system only supports a lower level of concurrency
2133 than <var>n</var>, the package should be built using as
2134 many parallel processes as the package build system
2135 supports. It is up to the package maintainer to decide
2136 whether the package build times are long enough and the
2137 package build system is robust enough to make supporting
2138 parallel builds worthwhile.
2139 </item>
2140 </taglist>
2141 </p>
2144 Unknown flags must be ignored by <file>debian/rules</file>.
2145 </p>
2148 The following makefile snippet is an example of how one may
2149 implement the build options; you will probably have to
2150 massage this example in order to make it work for your
2151 package.
2152 <example compact="compact">
2153 CFLAGS = -Wall -g
2154 INSTALL = install
2155 INSTALL_FILE = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 644
2156 INSTALL_PROGRAM = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2157 INSTALL_SCRIPT = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2158 INSTALL_DIR = $(INSTALL) -p -d -o root -g root -m 755
2160 ifneq (,$(filter noopt,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2161 CFLAGS += -O0
2162 else
2163 CFLAGS += -O2
2164 endif
2165 ifeq (,$(filter nostrip,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2166 INSTALL_PROGRAM += -s
2167 endif
2168 ifneq (,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2169 NUMJOBS = $(patsubst parallel=%,%,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2170 MAKEFLAGS += -j$(NUMJOBS)
2171 endif
2173 build:
2174 # ...
2175 ifeq (,$(filter nocheck,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2176 # Code to run the package test suite.
2177 endif
2178 </example>
2179 </p>
2180 </sect1>
2181 </sect>
2183 <!-- FIXME: section pkg-srcsubstvars is the same as substvars -->
2184 <sect id="substvars">
2185 <heading>Variable substitutions: <file>debian/substvars</file></heading>
2188 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2189 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2190 generate control files they perform variable substitutions
2191 on their output just before writing it. Variable
2192 substitutions have the form <tt>${<var>variable</var>}</tt>.
2193 The optional file <file>debian/substvars</file> contains
2194 variable substitutions to be used; variables can also be set
2195 directly from <file>debian/rules</file> using the <tt>-V</tt>
2196 option to the source packaging commands, and certain
2197 predefined variables are also available.
2198 </p>
2201 The <file>debian/substvars</file> file is usually generated and
2202 modified dynamically by <file>debian/rules</file> targets, in
2203 which case it must be removed by the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2204 </p>
2207 See <manref name="deb-substvars" section="5"> for full
2208 details about source variable substitutions, including the
2209 format of <file>debian/substvars</file>.</p>
2210 </sect>
2212 <sect id="debianwatch">
2213 <heading>Optional upstream source location: <file>debian/watch</file></heading>
2216 This is an optional, recommended control file for the
2217 <tt>uscan</tt> utility which defines how to automatically
2218 scan ftp or http sites for newly available updates of the
2219 package. This is used by <url id="
2220 http://dehs.alioth.debian.org/"> and other Debian QA tools
2221 to help with quality control and maintenance of the
2222 distribution as a whole.
2223 </p>
2225 </sect>
2227 <sect id="debianfiles">
2228 <heading>Generated files list: <file>debian/files</file></heading>
2231 This file is not a permanent part of the source tree; it
2232 is used while building packages to record which files are
2233 being generated. <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> uses it
2234 when it generates a <file>.changes</file> file.
2235 </p>
2238 It should not exist in a shipped source package, and so it
2239 (and any backup files or temporary files such as
2240 <file>files.new</file><footnote>
2241 <file>files.new</file> is used as a temporary file by
2242 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> and
2243 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - they write a new
2244 version of <tt>files</tt> here before renaming it,
2245 to avoid leaving a corrupted copy if an error
2246 occurs.
2247 </footnote>) should be removed by the
2248 <tt>clean</tt> target. It may also be wise to
2249 ensure a fresh start by emptying or removing it at the
2250 start of the <tt>binary</tt> target.
2251 </p>
2254 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> is run for a binary
2255 package, it adds an entry to <file>debian/files</file> for the
2256 <file>.deb</file> file that will be created when <tt>dpkg-deb
2257 --build</tt> is run for that binary package. So for most
2258 packages all that needs to be done with this file is to
2259 delete it in the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2260 </p>
2263 If a package upload includes files besides the source
2264 package and any binary packages whose control files were
2265 made with <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> then they should be
2266 placed in the parent of the package's top-level directory
2267 and <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> should be called to add
2268 the file to the list in <file>debian/files</file>.</p>
2269 </sect>
2271 <sect id="embeddedfiles">
2272 <heading>Convenience copies of code</heading>
2275 Some software packages include in their distribution convenience
2276 copies of code from other software packages, generally so that
2277 users compiling from source don't have to download multiple
2278 packages. Debian packages should not make use of these
2279 convenience copies unless the included package is explicitly
2280 intended to be used in this way.<footnote>
2281 For example, parts of the GNU build system work like this.
2282 </footnote>
2283 If the included code is already in the Debian archive in the
2284 form of a library, the Debian packaging should ensure that
2285 binary packages reference the libraries already in Debian and
2286 the convenience copy is not used. If the included code is not
2287 already in Debian, it should be packaged separately as a
2288 prerequisite if possible.
2289 <footnote>
2290 Having multiple copies of the same code in Debian is
2291 inefficient, often creates either static linking or shared
2292 library conflicts, and, most importantly, increases the
2293 difficulty of handling security vulnerabilities in the
2294 duplicated code.
2295 </footnote>
2296 </p>
2297 </sect>
2299 <sect id="readmesource">
2300 <heading>Source package handling:
2301 <file>debian/README.source</file></heading>
2304 If running <prgn>dpkg-source -x</prgn> on a source package
2305 doesn't produce the source of the package, ready for editing,
2306 and allow one to make changes and run
2307 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> to produce a modified package
2308 without taking any additional steps, creating a
2309 <file>debian/README.source</file> documentation file is
2310 recommended. This file should explain how to do all of the
2311 following:
2312 <enumlist>
2313 <item>Generate the fully patched source, in a form ready for
2314 editing, that would be built to create Debian
2315 packages. Doing this with a <tt>patch</tt> target in
2316 <file>debian/rules</file> is recommended; see
2317 <ref id="debianrules">.</item>
2318 <item>Modify the source and save those modifications so that
2319 they will be applied when building the package.</item>
2320 <item>Remove source modifications that are currently being
2321 applied when building the package.</item>
2322 <item>Optionally, document what steps are necessary to
2323 upgrade the Debian source package to a new upstream version,
2324 if applicable.</item>
2325 </enumlist>
2326 This explanation should include specific commands and mention
2327 any additional required Debian packages. It should not assume
2328 familiarity with any specific Debian packaging system or patch
2329 management tools.
2330 </p>
2333 This explanation may refer to a documentation file installed by
2334 one of the package's build dependencies provided that the
2335 referenced documentation clearly explains these tasks and is not
2336 a general reference manual.
2337 </p>
2340 <file>debian/README.source</file> may also include any other
2341 information that would be helpful to someone modifying the
2342 source package. Even if the package doesn't fit the above
2343 description, maintainers are encouraged to document in a
2344 <file>debian/README.source</file> file any source package with a
2345 particularly complex or unintuitive source layout or build
2346 system (for example, a package that builds the same source
2347 multiple times to generate different binary packages).
2348 </p>
2349 </sect>
2350 </chapt>
2353 <chapt id="controlfields">
2354 <heading>Control files and their fields</heading>
2357 The package management system manipulates data represented in
2358 a common format, known as <em>control data</em>, stored in
2359 <em>control files</em>.
2360 Control files are used for source packages, binary packages and
2361 the <file>.changes</file> files which control the installation
2362 of uploaded files<footnote>
2363 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
2364 format.
2365 </footnote>.
2366 </p>
2368 <sect id="controlsyntax">
2369 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
2372 A control file consists of one or more paragraphs of
2373 fields<footnote>
2374 The paragraphs are also sometimes referred to as stanzas.
2375 </footnote>.
2376 The paragraphs are separated by blank lines. Some control
2377 files allow only one paragraph; others allow several, in
2378 which case each paragraph usually refers to a different
2379 package. (For example, in source packages, the first
2380 paragraph refers to the source package, and later paragraphs
2381 refer to binary packages generated from the source.)
2382 </p>
2385 Each paragraph consists of a series of data fields; each
2386 field consists of the field name, followed by a colon and
2387 then the data/value associated with that field. It ends at
2388 the end of the (logical) line. Horizontal whitespace
2389 (spaces and tabs) may occur immediately before or after the
2390 value and is ignored there; it is conventional to put a
2391 single space after the colon. For example, a field might
2393 <example compact="compact">
2394 Package: libc6
2395 </example>
2396 the field name is <tt>Package</tt> and the field value
2397 <tt>libc6</tt>.
2398 </p>
2401 A paragraph must not contain more than one instance of a
2402 particular field name.
2403 </p>
2406 Many fields' values may span several lines; in this case
2407 each continuation line must start with a space or a tab.
2408 Any trailing spaces or tabs at the end of individual
2409 lines of a field value are ignored.
2410 </p>
2413 In fields where it is specified that lines may not wrap,
2414 only a single line of data is allowed and whitespace is not
2415 significant in a field body. Whitespace must not appear
2416 inside names (of packages, architectures, files or anything
2417 else) or version numbers, or between the characters of
2418 multi-character version relationships.
2419 </p>
2422 Field names are not case-sensitive, but it is usual to
2423 capitalize the field names using mixed case as shown below.
2424 Field values are case-sensitive unless the description of the
2425 field says otherwise.
2426 </p>
2429 Blank lines, or lines consisting only of spaces and tabs,
2430 are not allowed within field values or between fields - that
2431 would mean a new paragraph.
2432 </p>
2435 All control files must be encoded in UTF-8.
2436 </p>
2437 </sect>
2439 <sect id="sourcecontrolfiles">
2440 <heading>Source package control files -- <file>debian/control</file></heading>
2443 The <file>debian/control</file> file contains the most vital
2444 (and version-independent) information about the source package
2445 and about the binary packages it creates.
2446 </p>
2449 The first paragraph of the control file contains information about
2450 the source package in general. The subsequent sets each describe a
2451 binary package that the source tree builds.
2452 </p>
2455 The fields in the general paragraph (the first one, for the source
2456 package) are:
2458 <list compact="compact">
2459 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2460 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2461 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2462 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2463 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2464 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2465 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2466 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2467 </list>
2468 </p>
2471 The fields in the binary package paragraphs are:
2473 <list compact="compact">
2474 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2475 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2476 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2477 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2478 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2479 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2480 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2481 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2482 </list>
2483 </p>
2486 The syntax and semantics of the fields are described below.
2487 </p>
2489 <!-- stuff -->
2492 These fields are used by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
2493 generate control files for binary packages (see below), by
2494 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> to generate the
2495 <tt>.changes</tt> file to accompany the upload, and by
2496 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it creates the
2497 <file>.dsc</file> source control file as part of a source
2498 archive. Many fields are permitted to span multiple lines in
2499 <file>debian/control</file> but not in any other control
2500 file. These tools are responsible for removing the line
2501 breaks from such fields when using fields from
2502 <file>debian/control</file> to generate other control files.
2503 </p>
2506 The fields here may contain variable references - their
2507 values will be substituted by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2508 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> or <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2509 when they generate output control files.
2510 See <ref id="substvars"> for details.
2511 </p>
2514 In addition to the control file syntax described <qref
2515 id="controlsyntax">above</qref>, this file may also contain
2516 comment lines starting with <tt>#</tt> without any preceding
2517 whitespace. All such lines are ignored, even in the middle of
2518 continuation lines for a multiline field, and do not end a
2519 multiline field.
2520 </p>
2522 </sect>
2524 <sect id="binarycontrolfiles">
2525 <heading>Binary package control files -- <file>DEBIAN/control</file></heading>
2528 The <file>DEBIAN/control</file> file contains the most vital
2529 (and version-dependent) information about a binary package.
2530 </p>
2533 The fields in this file are:
2535 <list compact="compact">
2536 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2537 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref></item>
2538 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2539 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2540 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2541 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2542 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2543 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2544 <item><qref id="f-Installed-Size"><tt>Installed-Size</tt></qref></item>
2545 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2546 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2547 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2548 </list>
2549 </p>
2550 </sect>
2552 <sect id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">
2553 <heading>Debian source control files -- <tt>.dsc</tt></heading>
2556 This file contains a series of fields, identified and
2557 separated just like the fields in the control file of
2558 a binary package. The fields are listed below; their
2559 syntax is described above, in <ref id="pkg-controlfields">.
2561 <list compact="compact">
2562 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2563 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2564 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2565 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2566 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2567 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref></item>
2568 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref></item>
2569 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2570 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2571 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2572 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2573 </list>
2574 </p>
2577 The source package control file is generated by
2578 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it builds the source
2579 archive, from other files in the source package,
2580 described above. When unpacking, it is checked against
2581 the files and directories in the other parts of the
2582 source package.
2583 </p>
2585 </sect>
2587 <sect id="debianchangesfiles">
2588 <heading>Debian changes files -- <file>.changes</file></heading>
2591 The .changes files are used by the Debian archive maintenance
2592 software to process updates to packages. They contain one
2593 paragraph which contains information from the
2594 <tt>debian/control</tt> file and other data about the
2595 source package gathered via <tt>debian/changelog</tt>
2596 and <tt>debian/rules</tt>.
2597 </p>
2600 The fields in this file are:
2602 <list compact="compact">
2603 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2604 <item><qref id="f-Date"><tt>Date</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2605 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2606 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2607 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2608 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2609 <item><qref id="f-Distribution"><tt>Distribution</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2610 <item><qref id="f-Urgency"><tt>Urgency</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2611 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2612 <item><qref id="f-Changed-By"><tt>Changed-By</tt></qref></item>
2613 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2614 <item><qref id="f-Closes"><tt>Closes</tt></qref></item>
2615 <item><qref id="f-Changes"><tt>Changes</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2616 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2617 </list>
2618 </p>
2619 </sect>
2621 <sect id="controlfieldslist">
2622 <heading>List of fields</heading>
2624 <sect1 id="f-Source">
2625 <heading><tt>Source</tt></heading>
2628 This field identifies the source package name.
2629 </p>
2632 In <file>debian/control</file> or a <file>.dsc</file> file,
2633 this field must contain only the name of the source package.
2634 </p>
2637 In a binary package control file or a <file>.changes</file>
2638 file, the source package name may be followed by a version
2639 number in parentheses<footnote>
2640 It is customary to leave a space after the package name
2641 if a version number is specified.
2642 </footnote>.
2643 This version number may be omitted (and is, by
2644 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>) if it has the same value as
2645 the <tt>Version</tt> field of the binary package in
2646 question. The field itself may be omitted from a binary
2647 package control file when the source package has the same
2648 name and version as the binary package.
2649 </p>
2652 Package names (both source and binary,
2653 see <ref id="f-Package">) must consist only of lower case
2654 letters (<tt>a-z</tt>), digits (<tt>0-9</tt>), plus
2655 (<tt>+</tt>) and minus (<tt>-</tt>) signs, and periods
2656 (<tt>.</tt>). They must be at least two characters long and
2657 must start with an alphanumeric character.
2658 </p>
2659 </sect1>
2661 <sect1 id="f-Maintainer">
2662 <heading><tt>Maintainer</tt></heading>
2665 The package maintainer's name and email address. The name
2666 should come first, then the email address inside angle
2667 brackets <tt>&lt;&gt</tt> (in RFC822 format).
2668 </p>
2671 If the maintainer's name contains a full stop then the
2672 whole field will not work directly as an email address due
2673 to a misfeature in the syntax specified in RFC822; a
2674 program using this field as an address must check for this
2675 and correct the problem if necessary (for example by
2676 putting the name in round brackets and moving it to the
2677 end, and bringing the email address forward).
2678 </p>
2679 </sect1>
2681 <sect1 id="f-Uploaders">
2682 <heading><tt>Uploaders</tt></heading>
2685 List of the names and email addresses of co-maintainers of
2686 the package, if any. If the package has other maintainers
2687 beside the one named in the
2688 <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer field</qref>, their
2689 names and email addresses should be listed here. The
2690 format is the same as that of the Maintainer tag, and
2691 multiple entries should be comma separated. Currently,
2692 this field is restricted to a single line of data. This
2693 is an optional field.
2694 </p>
2696 Any parser that interprets the Uploaders field in
2697 <file>debian/control</file> must permit it to span multiple
2698 lines. Line breaks in an Uploaders field that spans multiple
2699 lines are not significant and the semantics of the field are
2700 the same as if the line breaks had not been present.
2701 </p>
2702 </sect1>
2704 <sect1 id="f-Changed-By">
2705 <heading><tt>Changed-By</tt></heading>
2708 The name and email address of the person who changed the
2709 said package. Usually the name of the maintainer.
2710 All the rules for the Maintainer field apply here, too.
2711 </p>
2712 </sect1>
2714 <sect1 id="f-Section">
2715 <heading><tt>Section</tt></heading>
2718 This field specifies an application area into which the package
2719 has been classified. See <ref id="subsections">.
2720 </p>
2723 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2724 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2725 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2726 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2727 packages.
2728 </p>
2729 </sect1>
2731 <sect1 id="f-Priority">
2732 <heading><tt>Priority</tt></heading>
2735 This field represents how important it is that the user
2736 have the package installed. See <ref id="priorities">.
2737 </p>
2740 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2741 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2742 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2743 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2744 packages.
2745 </p>
2746 </sect1>
2748 <sect1 id="f-Package">
2749 <heading><tt>Package</tt></heading>
2752 The name of the binary package.
2753 </p>
2756 Binary package names must follow the same syntax and
2757 restrictions as source package names. See <ref id="f-Source">
2758 for the details.
2759 </p>
2760 </sect1>
2762 <sect1 id="f-Architecture">
2763 <heading><tt>Architecture</tt></heading>
2766 Depending on context and the control file used, the
2767 <tt>Architecture</tt> field can include the following sets of
2768 values:
2769 <list>
2770 <item>
2771 A unique single word identifying a Debian machine
2772 architecture as described in <ref id="arch-spec">.
2773 </item>
2774 <item>
2775 An architecture wildcard identifying a set of Debian
2776 machine architectures, see <ref id="arch-wildcard-spec">.
2777 <tt>any</tt> matches all Debian machine architectures
2778 and is the most frequently used.
2779 </item>
2780 <item>
2781 <tt>all</tt>, which indicates an
2782 architecture-independent package.
2783 </item>
2784 <item>
2785 <tt>source</tt>, which indicates a source package.
2786 </item>
2787 </list>
2788 </p>
2791 In the main <file>debian/control</file> file in the source
2792 package, this field may contain the special
2793 value <tt>all</tt>, the special architecture
2794 wildcard <tt>any</tt>, or a list of specific and wildcard
2795 architectures separated by spaces. If <tt>all</tt>
2796 or <tt>any</tt> appears, that value must be the entire
2797 contents of the field. Most packages will use
2798 either <tt>all</tt> or <tt>any</tt>.
2799 </p>
2802 Specifying a specific list of architectures indicates that the
2803 source will build an architecture-dependent package only on
2804 architectures included in the list. Specifying a list of
2805 architecture wildcards indicates that the source will build an
2806 architecture-dependent package on only those architectures
2807 that match any of the specified architecture wildcards.
2808 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
2809 other than <tt>any</tt> is for the minority of cases where a
2810 program is not portable or is not useful on some
2811 architectures. Where possible, the program should be made
2812 portable instead.
2813 </p>
2816 In the source package control file <file>.dsc</file>, this
2817 field may contain either the architecture
2818 wildcard <tt>any</tt> or a list of architectures and
2819 architecture wildcards separated by spaces. If a list is
2820 given, it may include (or consist solely of) the special
2821 value <tt>all</tt>. In other words, in <file>.dsc</file>
2822 files unlike the <file>debian/control</file>, <tt>all</tt> may
2823 occur in combination with specific architectures.
2824 The <tt>Architecture</tt> field in the source package control
2825 file <file>.dsc</file> is generally constructed from
2826 the <tt>Architecture</tt> fields in
2827 the <file>debian/control</file> in the source package.
2828 </p>
2831 Specifying <tt>any</tt> indicates that the source package
2832 isn't dependent on any particular architecture and should
2833 compile fine on any one. The produced binary package(s)
2834 will either be specific to whatever the current build
2835 architecture is or will be architecture-independent.
2836 </p>
2839 Specifying only <tt>all</tt> indicates that the source package
2840 will only build architecture-independent packages. If this is
2841 the case, <tt>all</tt> must be used rather than <tt>any</tt>;
2842 <tt>any</tt> implies that the source package will build at
2843 least one architecture-dependent package.
2844 </p>
2847 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
2848 indicates that the source will build an architecture-dependent
2849 package, and will only work correctly on the listed or
2850 matching architectures. If the source package also builds at
2851 least one architecture-independent package, <tt>all</tt> will
2852 also be included in the list.
2853 </p>
2856 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Architecture</tt>
2857 field lists the architecture(s) of the package(s) currently
2858 being uploaded. This will be a list; if the source for the
2859 package is also being uploaded, the special
2860 entry <tt>source</tt> is also present. <tt>all</tt> will be
2861 present if any architecture-independent packages are being
2862 uploaded. Architecture wildcards such as <tt>any</tt> must
2863 never occur in the <tt>Architecture</tt> field in
2864 the <file>.changes</file> file.
2865 </p>
2868 See <ref id="debianrules"> for information on how to get
2869 the architecture for the build process.
2870 </p>
2871 </sect1>
2873 <sect1 id="f-Essential">
2874 <heading><tt>Essential</tt></heading>
2877 This is a boolean field which may occur only in the
2878 control file of a binary package or in a per-package fields
2879 paragraph of a main source control data file.
2880 </p>
2883 If set to <tt>yes</tt> then the package management system
2884 will refuse to remove the package (upgrading and replacing
2885 it is still possible). The other possible value is <tt>no</tt>,
2886 which is the same as not having the field at all.
2887 </p>
2888 </sect1>
2890 <sect1>
2891 <heading>Package interrelationship fields:
2892 <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
2893 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>,
2894 <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
2895 <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Replaces</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>
2896 </heading>
2899 These fields describe the package's relationships with
2900 other packages. Their syntax and semantics are described
2901 in <ref id="relationships">.</p>
2902 </sect1>
2904 <sect1 id="f-Standards-Version">
2905 <heading><tt>Standards-Version</tt></heading>
2908 The most recent version of the standards (the policy
2909 manual and associated texts) with which the package
2910 complies.
2911 </p>
2914 The version number has four components: major and minor
2915 version number and major and minor patch level. When the
2916 standards change in a way that requires every package to
2917 change the major number will be changed. Significant
2918 changes that will require work in many packages will be
2919 signaled by a change to the minor number. The major patch
2920 level will be changed for any change to the meaning of the
2921 standards, however small; the minor patch level will be
2922 changed when only cosmetic, typographical or other edits
2923 are made which neither change the meaning of the document
2924 nor affect the contents of packages.
2925 </p>
2928 Thus only the first three components of the policy version
2929 are significant in the <em>Standards-Version</em> control
2930 field, and so either these three components or all four
2931 components may be specified.<footnote>
2932 In the past, people specified the full version number
2933 in the Standards-Version field, for example "2.3.0.0".
2934 Since minor patch-level changes don't introduce new
2935 policy, it was thought it would be better to relax
2936 policy and only require the first 3 components to be
2937 specified, in this example "2.3.0". All four
2938 components may still be used if someone wishes to do so.
2939 </footnote>
2940 </p>
2942 </sect1>
2944 <sect1 id="f-Version">
2945 <heading><tt>Version</tt></heading>
2948 The version number of a package. The format is:
2949 [<var>epoch</var><tt>:</tt>]<var>upstream_version</var>[<tt>-</tt><var>debian_revision</var>]
2950 </p>
2953 The three components here are:
2954 <taglist>
2955 <tag><var>epoch</var></tag>
2956 <item>
2958 This is a single (generally small) unsigned integer. It
2959 may be omitted, in which case zero is assumed. If it is
2960 omitted then the <var>upstream_version</var> may not
2961 contain any colons.
2962 </p>
2965 It is provided to allow mistakes in the version numbers
2966 of older versions of a package, and also a package's
2967 previous version numbering schemes, to be left behind.
2968 </p>
2969 </item>
2971 <tag><var>upstream_version</var></tag>
2972 <item>
2974 This is the main part of the version number. It is
2975 usually the version number of the original ("upstream")
2976 package from which the <file>.deb</file> file has been made,
2977 if this is applicable. Usually this will be in the same
2978 format as that specified by the upstream author(s);
2979 however, it may need to be reformatted to fit into the
2980 package management system's format and comparison
2981 scheme.
2982 </p>
2985 The comparison behavior of the package management system
2986 with respect to the <var>upstream_version</var> is
2987 described below. The <var>upstream_version</var>
2988 portion of the version number is mandatory.
2989 </p>
2992 The <var>upstream_version</var> may contain only
2993 alphanumerics<footnote>
2994 Alphanumerics are <tt>A-Za-z0-9</tt> only.
2995 </footnote>
2996 and the characters <tt>.</tt> <tt>+</tt> <tt>-</tt>
2997 <tt>:</tt> <tt>~</tt> (full stop, plus, hyphen, colon,
2998 tilde) and should start with a digit. If there is no
2999 <var>debian_revision</var> then hyphens are not allowed;
3000 if there is no <var>epoch</var> then colons are not
3001 allowed.
3002 </p>
3003 </item>
3005 <tag><var>debian_revision</var></tag>
3006 <item>
3008 This part of the version number specifies the version of
3009 the Debian package based on the upstream version. It
3010 may contain only alphanumerics and the characters
3011 <tt>+</tt> <tt>.</tt> <tt>~</tt> (plus, full stop,
3012 tilde) and is compared in the same way as the
3013 <var>upstream_version</var> is.
3014 </p>
3017 It is optional; if it isn't present then the
3018 <var>upstream_version</var> may not contain a hyphen.
3019 This format represents the case where a piece of
3020 software was written specifically to be turned into a
3021 Debian package, and so there is only one "debianisation"
3022 of it and therefore no revision indication is required.
3023 </p>
3026 It is conventional to restart the
3027 <var>debian_revision</var> at <tt>1</tt> each time the
3028 <var>upstream_version</var> is increased.
3029 </p>
3032 The package management system will break the version
3033 number apart at the last hyphen in the string (if there
3034 is one) to determine the <var>upstream_version</var> and
3035 <var>debian_revision</var>. The absence of a
3036 <var>debian_revision</var> is equivalent to a
3037 <var>debian_revision</var> of <tt>0</tt>.
3038 </p>
3039 </item>
3040 </taglist>
3041 </p>
3044 When comparing two version numbers, first the <var>epoch</var>
3045 of each are compared, then the <var>upstream_version</var> if
3046 <var>epoch</var> is equal, and then <var>debian_revision</var>
3047 if <var>upstream_version</var> is also equal.
3048 <var>epoch</var> is compared numerically. The
3049 <var>upstream_version</var> and <var>debian_revision</var>
3050 parts are compared by the package management system using the
3051 following algorithm:
3052 </p>
3055 The strings are compared from left to right.
3056 </p>
3059 First the initial part of each string consisting entirely of
3060 non-digit characters is determined. These two parts (one of
3061 which may be empty) are compared lexically. If a difference
3062 is found it is returned. The lexical comparison is a
3063 comparison of ASCII values modified so that all the letters
3064 sort earlier than all the non-letters and so that a tilde
3065 sorts before anything, even the end of a part. For example,
3066 the following parts are in sorted order from earliest to
3067 latest: <tt>~~</tt>, <tt>~~a</tt>, <tt>~</tt>, the empty part,
3068 <tt>a</tt>.<footnote>
3069 One common use of <tt>~</tt> is for upstream pre-releases.
3070 For example, <tt>1.0~beta1~svn1245</tt> sorts earlier than
3071 <tt>1.0~beta1</tt>, which sorts earlier than <tt>1.0</tt>.
3072 </footnote>
3073 </p>
3076 Then the initial part of the remainder of each string which
3077 consists entirely of digit characters is determined. The
3078 numerical values of these two parts are compared, and any
3079 difference found is returned as the result of the comparison.
3080 For these purposes an empty string (which can only occur at
3081 the end of one or both version strings being compared) counts
3082 as zero.
3083 </p>
3086 These two steps (comparing and removing initial non-digit
3087 strings and initial digit strings) are repeated until a
3088 difference is found or both strings are exhausted.
3089 </p>
3092 Note that the purpose of epochs is to allow us to leave behind
3093 mistakes in version numbering, and to cope with situations
3094 where the version numbering scheme changes. It is
3095 <em>not</em> intended to cope with version numbers containing
3096 strings of letters which the package management system cannot
3097 interpret (such as <tt>ALPHA</tt> or <tt>pre-</tt>), or with
3098 silly orderings.<footnote>
3099 The author of this manual has heard of a package whose
3100 versions went <tt>1.1</tt>, <tt>1.2</tt>, <tt>1.3</tt>,
3101 <tt>1</tt>, <tt>2.1</tt>, <tt>2.2</tt>, <tt>2</tt> and so
3102 forth.
3103 </footnote>
3104 </p>
3105 </sect1>
3107 <sect1 id="f-Description">
3108 <heading><tt>Description</tt></heading>
3111 In a source or binary control file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3112 field contains a description of the binary package, consisting
3113 of two parts, the synopsis or the short description, and the
3114 long description. The field's format is as follows:
3115 </p>
3118 <example>
3119 Description: &lt;single line synopsis&gt;
3120 &lt;extended description over several lines&gt;
3121 </example>
3122 </p>
3125 The lines in the extended description can have these formats:
3126 </p>
3128 <p><list>
3130 <item>
3131 Those starting with a single space are part of a paragraph.
3132 Successive lines of this form will be word-wrapped when
3133 displayed. The leading space will usually be stripped off.
3134 </item>
3136 <item>
3137 Those starting with two or more spaces. These will be
3138 displayed verbatim. If the display cannot be panned
3139 horizontally, the displaying program will line wrap them "hard"
3140 (i.e., without taking account of word breaks). If it can they
3141 will be allowed to trail off to the right. None, one or two
3142 initial spaces may be deleted, but the number of spaces
3143 deleted from each line will be the same (so that you can have
3144 indenting work correctly, for example).
3145 </item>
3147 <item>
3148 Those containing a single space followed by a single full stop
3149 character. These are rendered as blank lines. This is the
3150 <em>only</em> way to get a blank line<footnote>
3151 Completely empty lines will not be rendered as blank lines.
3152 Instead, they will cause the parser to think you're starting
3153 a whole new record in the control file, and will therefore
3154 likely abort with an error.
3155 </footnote>.
3156 </item>
3158 <item>
3159 Those containing a space, a full stop and some more characters.
3160 These are for future expansion. Do not use them.
3161 </item>
3163 </list></p>
3166 Do not use tab characters. Their effect is not predictable.
3167 </p>
3170 See <ref id="descriptions"> for further information on this.
3171 </p>
3174 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3175 field contains a summary of the descriptions for the packages
3176 being uploaded. For this case, the first line of the field
3177 value (the part on the same line as <tt>Description:</tt>) is
3178 always empty. The content of the field is expressed as
3179 continuation lines, one line per package. Each line is
3180 indented by one space and contains the name of a binary
3181 package, a space, a hyphen (<tt>-</tt>), a space, and the
3182 short description line from that package.
3183 </p>
3184 </sect1>
3186 <sect1 id="f-Distribution">
3187 <heading><tt>Distribution</tt></heading>
3190 In a <file>.changes</file> file or parsed changelog output
3191 this contains the (space-separated) name(s) of the
3192 distribution(s) where this version of the package should
3193 be installed. Valid distributions are determined by the
3194 archive maintainers.<footnote>
3195 Example distribution names in the Debian archive used in
3196 <file>.changes</file> files are:
3197 <taglist compact="compact">
3198 <tag><em>unstable</em></tag>
3199 <item>
3200 This distribution value refers to the
3201 <em>developmental</em> part of the Debian distribution
3202 tree. Most new packages, new upstream versions of
3203 packages and bug fixes go into the <em>unstable</em>
3204 directory tree.
3205 </item>
3207 <tag><em>experimental</em></tag>
3208 <item>
3209 The packages with this distribution value are deemed
3210 by their maintainers to be high risk. Oftentimes they
3211 represent early beta or developmental packages from
3212 various sources that the maintainers want people to
3213 try, but are not ready to be a part of the other parts
3214 of the Debian distribution tree.
3215 </item>
3216 </taglist>
3219 Others are used for updating stable releases or for
3220 security uploads. More information is available in the
3221 Debian Developer's Reference, section "The Debian
3222 archive".
3223 </p>
3224 </footnote>
3225 The Debian archive software only supports listing a single
3226 distribution. Migration of packages to other distributions is
3227 handled outside of the upload process.
3228 </p>
3229 </sect1>
3231 <sect1 id="f-Date">
3232 <heading><tt>Date</tt></heading>
3235 This field includes the date the package was built or last
3236 edited. It must be in the same format as the <var>date</var>
3237 in a <file>debian/changelog</file> entry.
3238 </p>
3241 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3242 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3243 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3244 </p>
3245 </sect1>
3247 <sect1 id="f-Format">
3248 <heading><tt>Format</tt></heading>
3251 This field specifies a format revision for the file.
3252 The most current format described in the Policy Manual
3253 is version <strong>1.5</strong>. The syntax of the
3254 format value is the same as that of a package version
3255 number except that no epoch or Debian revision is allowed
3256 - see <ref id="f-Version">.
3257 </p>
3258 </sect1>
3260 <sect1 id="f-Urgency">
3261 <heading><tt>Urgency</tt></heading>
3264 This is a description of how important it is to upgrade to
3265 this version from previous ones. It consists of a single
3266 keyword taking one of the values <tt>low</tt>,
3267 <tt>medium</tt>, <tt>high</tt>, <tt>emergency</tt>, or
3268 <tt>critical</tt><footnote>
3269 Other urgency values are supported with configuration
3270 changes in the archive software but are not used in Debian.
3271 The urgency affects how quickly a package will be considered
3272 for inclusion into the <tt>testing</tt> distribution and
3273 gives an indication of the importance of any fixes included
3274 in the upload. <tt>Emergency</tt> and <tt>critical</tt> are
3275 treated as synonymous.
3276 </footnote> (not case-sensitive) followed by an optional
3277 commentary (separated by a space) which is usually in
3278 parentheses. For example:
3280 <example>
3281 Urgency: low (HIGH for users of diversions)
3282 </example>
3284 </p>
3287 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3288 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3289 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
3290 </p>
3291 </sect1>
3293 <sect1 id="f-Changes">
3294 <heading><tt>Changes</tt></heading>
3297 This field contains the human-readable changes data, describing
3298 the differences between the last version and the current one.
3299 </p>
3302 The first line of the field value (the part on the same line
3303 as <tt>Changes:</tt>) is always empty. The content of the
3304 field is expressed as continuation lines, with each line
3305 indented by at least one space. Blank lines must be
3306 represented by a line consisting only of a space and a full
3307 stop (<tt>.</tt>).
3308 </p>
3311 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3312 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3313 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3314 </p>
3317 Each version's change information should be preceded by a
3318 "title" line giving at least the version, distribution(s)
3319 and urgency, in a human-readable way.
3320 </p>
3323 If data from several versions is being returned the entry
3324 for the most recent version should be returned first, and
3325 entries should be separated by the representation of a
3326 blank line (the "title" line may also be followed by the
3327 representation of a blank line).
3328 </p>
3329 </sect1>
3331 <sect1 id="f-Binary">
3332 <heading><tt>Binary</tt></heading>
3335 This field is a list of binary packages. Its syntax and
3336 meaning varies depending on the control file in which it
3337 appears.
3338 </p>
3341 When it appears in the <file>.dsc</file> file, it lists binary
3342 packages which a source package can produce, separated by
3343 commas<footnote>
3344 A space after each comma is conventional.
3345 </footnote>. It may span multiple lines. The source package
3346 does not necessarily produce all of these binary packages for
3347 every architecture. The source control file doesn't contain
3348 details of which architectures are appropriate for which of
3349 the binary packages.
3350 </p>
3353 When it appears in a <file>.changes</file> file, it lists the
3354 names of the binary packages being uploaded, separated by
3355 whitespace (not commas). It may span multiple lines.
3356 </p>
3357 </sect1>
3359 <sect1 id="f-Installed-Size">
3360 <heading><tt>Installed-Size</tt></heading>
3363 This field appears in the control files of binary packages,
3364 and in the <file>Packages</file> files. It gives an estimate
3365 of the total amount of disk space required to install the
3366 named package. Actual installed size may vary based on block
3367 size, file system properties, or actions taken by package
3368 maintainer scripts.
3369 </p>
3372 The disk space is given as the integer value of the estimated
3373 installed size in bytes, divided by 1024 and rounded up.
3374 </p>
3375 </sect1>
3377 <sect1 id="f-Files">
3378 <heading><tt>Files</tt></heading>
3381 This field contains a list of files with information about
3382 each one. The exact information and syntax varies with
3383 the context.
3384 </p>
3387 In all cases, Files is a multiline field. The first line of
3388 the field value (the part on the same line as <tt>Files:</tt>)
3389 is always empty. The content of the field is expressed as
3390 continuation lines, one line per file. Each line must be
3391 indented by one space and contain a number of sub-fields,
3392 separated by spaces, as described below.
3393 </p>
3396 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, each line contains the MD5
3397 checksum, size and filename of the tar file and (if
3398 applicable) diff file which make up the remainder of the
3399 source package<footnote>
3400 That is, the parts which are not the <tt>.dsc</tt>.
3401 </footnote>. For example:
3402 <example>
3403 Files:
3404 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3405 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3406 </example>
3407 The exact forms of the filenames are described
3408 in <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.
3409 </p>
3412 In the <file>.changes</file> file this contains one line per
3413 file being uploaded. Each line contains the MD5 checksum,
3414 size, section and priority and the filename. For example:
3415 <example>
3416 Files:
3417 4c31ab7bfc40d3cf49d7811987390357 1428 text extra example_1.2-1.dsc
3418 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 text extra example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3419 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 text extra example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3420 7c98fe853b3bbb47a00e5cd129b6cb56 703542 text extra example_1.2-1_i386.deb
3421 </example>
3422 The <qref id="f-Section">section</qref>
3423 and <qref id="f-Priority">priority</qref> are the values of
3424 the corresponding fields in the main source control file. If
3425 no section or priority is specified then <tt>-</tt> should be
3426 used, though section and priority values must be specified for
3427 new packages to be installed properly.
3428 </p>
3431 The special value <tt>byhand</tt> for the section in a
3432 <tt>.changes</tt> file indicates that the file in question
3433 is not an ordinary package file and must by installed by
3434 hand by the distribution maintainers. If the section is
3435 <tt>byhand</tt> the priority should be <tt>-</tt>.
3436 </p>
3439 If a new Debian revision of a package is being shipped and
3440 no new original source archive is being distributed the
3441 <tt>.dsc</tt> must still contain the <tt>Files</tt> field
3442 entry for the original source archive
3443 <file><var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz</file>,
3444 but the <file>.changes</file> file should leave it out. In
3445 this case the original source archive on the distribution
3446 site must match exactly, byte-for-byte, the original
3447 source archive which was used to generate the
3448 <file>.dsc</file> file and diff which are being uploaded.</p>
3449 </sect1>
3451 <sect1 id="f-Closes">
3452 <heading><tt>Closes</tt></heading>
3455 A space-separated list of bug report numbers that the upload
3456 governed by the .changes file closes.
3457 </p>
3458 </sect1>
3460 <sect1 id="f-Homepage">
3461 <heading><tt>Homepage</tt></heading>
3464 The URL of the web site for this package, preferably (when
3465 applicable) the site from which the original source can be
3466 obtained and any additional upstream documentation or
3467 information may be found. The content of this field is a
3468 simple URL without any surrounding characters such as
3469 <tt>&lt;&gt;</tt>.
3470 </p>
3471 </sect1>
3473 </sect>
3475 <sect>
3476 <heading>User-defined fields</heading>
3479 Additional user-defined fields may be added to the
3480 source package control file. Such fields will be
3481 ignored, and not copied to (for example) binary or
3482 source package control files or upload control files.
3483 </p>
3486 If you wish to add additional unsupported fields to
3487 these output files you should use the mechanism
3488 described here.
3489 </p>
3492 Fields in the main source control information file with
3493 names starting <tt>X</tt>, followed by one or more of
3494 the letters <tt>BCS</tt> and a hyphen <tt>-</tt>, will
3495 be copied to the output files. Only the part of the
3496 field name after the hyphen will be used in the output
3497 file. Where the letter <tt>B</tt> is used the field
3498 will appear in binary package control files, where the
3499 letter <tt>S</tt> is used in source package control
3500 files and where <tt>C</tt> is used in upload control
3501 (<tt>.changes</tt>) files.
3502 </p>
3505 For example, if the main source information control file
3506 contains the field
3507 <example>
3508 XBS-Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3509 </example>
3510 then the binary and source package control files will contain the
3511 field
3512 <example>
3513 Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3514 </example>
3515 </p>
3517 </sect>
3519 </chapt>
3522 <chapt id="maintainerscripts">
3523 <heading>Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure</heading>
3525 <sect>
3526 <heading>Introduction to package maintainer scripts</heading>
3529 It is possible to supply scripts as part of a package which
3530 the package management system will run for you when your
3531 package is installed, upgraded or removed.
3532 </p>
3535 These scripts are the files <prgn>preinst</prgn>,
3536 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> and
3537 <prgn>postrm</prgn> in the control area of the package.
3538 They must be proper executable files; if they are scripts
3539 (which is recommended), they must start with the usual
3540 <tt>#!</tt> convention. They should be readable and
3541 executable by anyone, and must not be world-writable.
3542 </p>
3545 The package management system looks at the exit status from
3546 these scripts. It is important that they exit with a
3547 non-zero status if there is an error, so that the package
3548 management system can stop its processing. For shell
3549 scripts this means that you <em>almost always</em> need to
3550 use <tt>set -e</tt> (this is usually true when writing shell
3551 scripts, in fact). It is also important, of course, that
3552 they exit with a zero status if everything went well.
3553 </p>
3556 Additionally, packages interacting with users using
3557 <tt>debconf</tt> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script should
3558 install a <prgn>config</prgn> script in the control area,
3559 see <ref id="maintscriptprompt"> for details.
3560 </p>
3563 When a package is upgraded a combination of the scripts from
3564 the old and new packages is called during the upgrade
3565 procedure. If your scripts are going to be at all
3566 complicated you need to be aware of this, and may need to
3567 check the arguments to your scripts.
3568 </p>
3571 Broadly speaking the <prgn>preinst</prgn> is called before
3572 (a particular version of) a package is installed, and the
3573 <prgn>postinst</prgn> afterwards; the <prgn>prerm</prgn>
3574 before (a version of) a package is removed and the
3575 <prgn>postrm</prgn> afterwards.
3576 </p>
3579 Programs called from maintainer scripts should not normally
3580 have a path prepended to them. Before installation is
3581 started, the package management system checks to see if the
3582 programs <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>,
3583 <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn>, <prgn>install-info</prgn>,
3584 and <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> can be found via the
3585 <tt>PATH</tt> environment variable. Those programs, and any
3586 other program that one would expect to be in the
3587 <tt>PATH</tt>, should thus be invoked without an absolute
3588 pathname. Maintainer scripts should also not reset the
3589 <tt>PATH</tt>, though they might choose to modify it by
3590 prepending or appending package-specific directories. These
3591 considerations really apply to all shell scripts.</p>
3592 </sect>
3594 <sect id="idempotency">
3595 <heading>Maintainer scripts idempotency</heading>
3598 It is necessary for the error recovery procedures that the
3599 scripts be idempotent. This means that if it is run
3600 successfully, and then it is called again, it doesn't bomb
3601 out or cause any harm, but just ensures that everything is
3602 the way it ought to be. If the first call failed, or
3603 aborted half way through for some reason, the second call
3604 should merely do the things that were left undone the first
3605 time, if any, and exit with a success status if everything
3606 is OK.<footnote>
3607 This is so that if an error occurs, the user interrupts
3608 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> or some other unforeseen circumstance
3609 happens you don't leave the user with a badly-broken
3610 package when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> attempts to repeat the
3611 action.
3612 </footnote>
3613 </p>
3614 </sect>
3616 <sect id="controllingterminal">
3617 <heading>Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts</heading>
3620 Maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a controlling
3621 terminal and may not be able to interact with the user. They
3622 must be able to fall back to noninteractive behavior if no
3623 controlling terminal is available. Maintainer scripts that
3624 prompt via a program conforming to the Debian Configuration
3625 Management Specification (see <ref id="maintscriptprompt">) may
3626 assume that program will handle falling back to noninteractive
3627 behavior.
3628 </p>
3631 For high-priority prompts without a reasonable default answer,
3632 maintainer scripts may abort if there is no controlling
3633 terminal. However, this situation should be avoided if at all
3634 possible, since it prevents automated or unattended installs.
3635 In most cases, users will consider this to be a bug in the
3636 package.
3637 </p>
3638 </sect>
3640 <sect id="exitstatus">
3641 <heading>Exit status</heading>
3644 Each script must return a zero exit status for
3645 success, or a nonzero one for failure, since the package
3646 management system looks for the exit status of these scripts
3647 and determines what action to take next based on that datum.
3648 </p>
3649 </sect>
3651 <sect id="mscriptsinstact"><heading>Summary of ways maintainer
3652 scripts are called
3653 </heading>
3656 <list compact="compact">
3657 <item>
3658 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt>
3659 </item>
3660 <item>
3661 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3662 </item>
3663 <item>
3664 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>upgrade</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3665 </item>
3666 <item>
3667 <var>old-preinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3668 <var>new-version</var>
3669 </item>
3670 </list>
3673 <list compact="compact">
3674 <item>
3675 <var>postinst</var> <tt>configure</tt>
3676 <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
3677 </item>
3678 <item>
3679 <var>old-postinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3680 <var>new-version</var>
3681 </item>
3682 <item>
3683 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3684 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3685 <var>new-version</var>
3686 </item>
3687 <item>
3688 <var>postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3689 </item>
3690 <item>
3691 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var>
3692 <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt> <tt>in-favour</tt>
3693 <var>failed-install-package</var> <var>version</var>
3694 [<tt>removing</tt> <var>conflicting-package</var>
3695 <var>version</var>]
3696 </item>
3697 </list>
3700 <list compact="compact">
3701 <item>
3702 <var>prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3703 </item>
3704 <item>
3705 <var>old-prerm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3706 <var>new-version</var>
3707 </item>
3708 <item>
3709 <var>new-prerm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3710 <var>old-version</var>
3711 </item>
3712 <item>
3713 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3714 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3715 <var>new-version</var>
3716 </item>
3717 <item>
3718 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> <tt>deconfigure</tt>
3719 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package-being-installed</var>
3720 <var>version</var> [<tt>removing</tt>
3721 <var>conflicting-package</var>
3722 <var>version</var>]
3723 </item>
3724 </list>
3727 <list compact="compact">
3728 <item>
3729 <var>postrm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3730 </item>
3731 <item>
3732 <var>postrm</var> <tt>purge</tt>
3733 </item>
3734 <item>
3735 <var>old-postrm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3736 <var>new-version</var>
3737 </item>
3738 <item>
3739 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3740 <var>old-version</var>
3741 </item>
3742 <item>
3743 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3744 </item>
3745 <item>
3746 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3747 <var>old-version</var>
3748 </item>
3749 <item>
3750 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3751 <var>old-version</var>
3752 </item>
3753 <item>
3754 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> <tt>disappear</tt>
3755 <var>overwriter</var>
3756 <var>overwriter-version</var>
3757 </item>
3758 </list>
3759 </p>
3762 <sect id="unpackphase">
3763 <heading>Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade</heading>
3766 The procedure on installation/upgrade/overwrite/disappear
3767 (i.e., when running <tt>dpkg --unpack</tt>, or the unpack
3768 stage of <tt>dpkg --install</tt>) is as follows. In each
3769 case, if a major error occurs (unless listed below) the
3770 actions are, in general, run backwards - this means that the
3771 maintainer scripts are run with different arguments in
3772 reverse order. These are the "error unwind" calls listed
3773 below.
3775 <enumlist>
3776 <item>
3777 <enumlist>
3778 <item>
3779 If a version of the package is already installed, call
3780 <example compact="compact">
3781 <var>old-prerm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3782 </example>
3783 </item>
3784 <item>
3785 If the script runs but exits with a non-zero
3786 exit status, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
3787 <example compact="compact">
3788 <var>new-prerm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3789 </example>
3790 If this works, the upgrade continues. If this
3791 does not work, the error unwind:
3792 <example compact="compact">
3793 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3794 </example>
3795 If this works, then the old-version is
3796 "Installed", if not, the old version is in a
3797 "Half-Configured" state.
3798 </item>
3799 </enumlist>
3800 </item>
3802 <item>
3803 If a "conflicting" package is being removed at the same time,
3804 or if any package will be broken (due to <tt>Breaks</tt>):
3805 <enumlist>
3806 <item>
3807 If <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3808 specified, call, for each package to be deconfigured
3809 due to <tt>Breaks</tt>:
3810 <example compact="compact">
3811 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3812 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var>
3813 </example>
3814 Error unwind:
3815 <example compact="compact">
3816 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3817 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var>
3818 </example>
3819 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3820 requiring configuration, so that if
3821 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3822 configured again if possible.
3823 </item>
3824 <item>
3825 If any packages depended on a conflicting
3826 package being removed and <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3827 specified, call, for each such package:
3828 <example compact="compact">
3829 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3830 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var> \
3831 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3832 </example>
3833 Error unwind:
3834 <example compact="compact">
3835 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3836 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var> \
3837 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3838 </example>
3839 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3840 requiring configuration, so that if
3841 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3842 configured again if possible.
3843 </item>
3844 <item>
3845 To prepare for removal of each conflicting package, call:
3846 <example compact="compact">
3847 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> remove \
3848 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3849 </example>
3850 Error unwind:
3851 <example compact="compact">
3852 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
3853 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3854 </example>
3855 </item>
3856 </enumlist>
3857 </item>
3859 <item>
3860 <enumlist>
3861 <item>
3862 If the package is being upgraded, call:
3863 <example compact="compact">
3864 <var>new-preinst</var> upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3865 </example>
3866 If this fails, we call:
3867 <example>
3868 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3869 </example>
3870 <enumlist>
3871 <item>
3873 If that works, then
3874 <example>
3875 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3876 </example>
3877 is called. If this works, then the old version
3878 is in an "Installed" state, or else it is left
3879 in an "Unpacked" state.
3880 </p>
3881 </item>
3882 <item>
3884 If it fails, then the old version is left
3885 in an "Half-Installed" state.
3886 </p>
3887 </item>
3888 </enumlist>
3890 </item>
3891 <item>
3892 Otherwise, if the package had some configuration
3893 files from a previous version installed (i.e., it
3894 is in the "configuration files only" state):
3895 <example compact="compact">
3896 <var>new-preinst</var> install <var>old-version</var>
3897 </example>
3898 Error unwind:
3899 <example>
3900 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install <var>old-version</var>
3901 </example>
3902 If this fails, the package is left in a
3903 "Half-Installed" state, which requires a
3904 reinstall. If it works, the packages is left in
3905 a "Config-Files" state.
3906 </item>
3907 <item>
3908 Otherwise (i.e., the package was completely purged):
3909 <example compact="compact">
3910 <var>new-preinst</var> install
3911 </example>
3912 Error unwind:
3913 <example compact="compact">
3914 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install
3915 </example>
3916 If the error-unwind fails, the package is in a
3917 "Half-Installed" phase, and requires a
3918 reinstall. If the error unwind works, the
3919 package is in a not installed state.
3920 </item>
3921 </enumlist>
3922 </item>
3924 <item>
3926 The new package's files are unpacked, overwriting any
3927 that may be on the system already, for example any
3928 from the old version of the same package or from
3929 another package. Backups of the old files are kept
3930 temporarily, and if anything goes wrong the package
3931 management system will attempt to put them back as
3932 part of the error unwind.
3933 </p>
3936 It is an error for a package to contain files which
3937 are on the system in another package, unless
3938 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used (see <ref id="replaces">).
3939 <!--
3940 The following paragraph is not currently the case:
3941 Currently the <tt>- - force-overwrite</tt> flag is
3942 enabled, downgrading it to a warning, but this may not
3943 always be the case.
3945 </p>
3948 It is a more serious error for a package to contain a
3949 plain file or other kind of non-directory where another
3950 package has a directory (again, unless
3951 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used). This error can be
3952 overridden if desired using
3953 <tt>--force-overwrite-dir</tt>, but this is not
3954 advisable.
3955 </p>
3958 Packages which overwrite each other's files produce
3959 behavior which, though deterministic, is hard for the
3960 system administrator to understand. It can easily
3961 lead to "missing" programs if, for example, a package
3962 is installed which overwrites a file from another
3963 package, and is then removed again.<footnote>
3964 Part of the problem is due to what is arguably a
3965 bug in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
3966 </footnote>
3967 </p>
3970 A directory will never be replaced by a symbolic link
3971 to a directory or vice versa; instead, the existing
3972 state (symlink or not) will be left alone and
3973 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will follow the symlink if there is
3974 one.
3975 </p>
3976 </item>
3978 <item>
3980 <enumlist>
3981 <item>
3982 If the package is being upgraded, call
3983 <example compact="compact">
3984 <var>old-postrm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3985 </example>
3986 </item>
3987 <item>
3988 If this fails, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
3989 <example compact="compact">
3990 <var>new-postrm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3991 </example>
3992 If this works, installation continues. If not,
3993 Error unwind:
3994 <example compact="compact">
3995 <var>old-preinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3996 </example>
3997 If this fails, the old version is left in a
3998 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
3999 calls:
4000 <example compact="compact">
4001 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4002 </example>
4003 If this fails, the old version is left in a
4004 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
4005 calls:
4006 <example compact="compact">
4007 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4008 </example>
4009 If this fails, the old version is in an
4010 "Unpacked" state.
4011 </item>
4012 </enumlist>
4013 </p>
4016 This is the point of no return - if
4017 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> gets this far, it won't back off
4018 past this point if an error occurs. This will
4019 leave the package in a fairly bad state, which
4020 will require a successful re-installation to clear
4021 up, but it's when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> starts doing
4022 things that are irreversible.
4023 </p>
4024 </item>
4026 <item>
4027 Any files which were in the old version of the package
4028 but not in the new are removed.
4029 </item>
4031 <item>
4032 The new file list replaces the old.
4033 </item>
4035 <item>
4036 The new maintainer scripts replace the old.
4037 </item>
4039 <item>
4040 Any packages all of whose files have been overwritten
4041 during the installation, and which aren't required for
4042 dependencies, are considered to have been removed.
4043 For each such package
4044 <enumlist>
4045 <item>
4046 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> calls:
4047 <example compact="compact">
4048 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> disappear \
4049 <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var>
4050 </example>
4051 </item>
4052 <item>
4053 The package's maintainer scripts are removed.
4054 </item>
4055 <item>
4056 It is noted in the status database as being in a
4057 sane state, namely not installed (any conffiles
4058 it may have are ignored, rather than being
4059 removed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>). Note that
4060 disappearing packages do not have their prerm
4061 called, because <prgn>dpkg</prgn> doesn't know
4062 in advance that the package is going to
4063 vanish.
4064 </item>
4065 </enumlist>
4066 </item>
4068 <item>
4069 Any files in the package we're unpacking that are also
4070 listed in the file lists of other packages are removed
4071 from those lists. (This will lobotomize the file list
4072 of the "conflicting" package if there is one.)
4073 </item>
4075 <item>
4076 The backup files made during installation, above, are
4077 deleted.
4078 </item>
4080 <item>
4082 The new package's status is now sane, and recorded as
4083 "unpacked".
4084 </p>
4087 Here is another point of no return - if the
4088 conflicting package's removal fails we do not unwind
4089 the rest of the installation; the conflicting package
4090 is left in a half-removed limbo.
4091 </p>
4092 </item>
4094 <item>
4095 If there was a conflicting package we go and do the
4096 removal actions (described below), starting with the
4097 removal of the conflicting package's files (any that
4098 are also in the package being installed have already
4099 been removed from the conflicting package's file list,
4100 and so do not get removed now).
4101 </item>
4102 </enumlist>
4103 </p>
4104 </sect>
4106 <sect id="configdetails"><heading>Details of configuration</heading>
4109 When we configure a package (this happens with <tt>dpkg
4110 --install</tt> and <tt>dpkg --configure</tt>), we first
4111 update any <tt>conffile</tt>s and then call:
4112 <example compact="compact">
4113 <var>postinst</var> configure <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
4114 </example>
4115 </p>
4118 No attempt is made to unwind after errors during
4119 configuration. If the configuration fails, the package is in
4120 a "Failed Config" state, and an error message is generated.
4121 </p>
4124 If there is no most recently configured version
4125 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will pass a null argument.
4126 <footnote>
4128 Historical note: Truly ancient (pre-1997) versions of
4129 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> passed <tt>&lt;unknown&gt;</tt>
4130 (including the angle brackets) in this case. Even older
4131 ones did not pass a second argument at all, under any
4132 circumstance. Note that upgrades using such an old dpkg
4133 version are unlikely to work for other reasons, even if
4134 this old argument behavior is handled by your postinst script.
4135 </p>
4136 </footnote>
4137 </p>
4138 </sect>
4140 <sect id="removedetails"><heading>Details of removal and/or
4141 configuration purging</heading>
4144 <enumlist>
4145 <item>
4147 <example compact="compact">
4148 <var>prerm</var> remove
4149 </example>
4150 </p>
4152 If prerm fails during replacement due to conflict
4153 <example>
4154 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
4155 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4156 </example>
4157 Or else we call:
4158 <example>
4159 <var>postinst</var> abort-remove
4160 </example>
4161 </p>
4163 If this fails, the package is in a "Half-Configured"
4164 state, or else it remains "Installed".
4165 </p>
4166 </item>
4167 <item>
4168 The package's files are removed (except <tt>conffile</tt>s).
4169 </item>
4170 <item>
4171 <example compact="compact">
4172 <var>postrm</var> remove
4173 </example>
4176 If it fails, there's no error unwind, and the package is in
4177 an "Half-Installed" state.
4178 </p>
4179 </item>
4180 <item>
4182 All the maintainer scripts except the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4183 are removed.
4184 </p>
4187 If we aren't purging the package we stop here. Note
4188 that packages which have no <prgn>postrm</prgn> and no
4189 <tt>conffile</tt>s are automatically purged when
4190 removed, as there is no difference except for the
4191 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> status.
4192 </p>
4193 </item>
4194 <item>
4195 The <tt>conffile</tt>s and any backup files
4196 (<tt>~</tt>-files, <tt>#*#</tt> files,
4197 <tt>%</tt>-files, <tt>.dpkg-{old,new,tmp}</tt>, etc.)
4198 are removed.
4199 </item>
4200 <item>
4202 <example compact="compact">
4203 <var>postrm</var> purge
4204 </example>
4205 </p>
4207 If this fails, the package remains in a "Config-Files"
4208 state.
4209 </p>
4210 </item>
4211 <item>
4212 The package's file list is removed.
4213 </item>
4214 </enumlist>
4216 </p>
4217 </sect>
4218 </chapt>
4221 <chapt id="relationships">
4222 <heading>Declaring relationships between packages</heading>
4224 <sect id="depsyntax">
4225 <heading>Syntax of relationship fields</heading>
4228 These fields all have a uniform syntax. They are a list of
4229 package names separated by commas.
4230 </p>
4233 In the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Recommends</tt>,
4234 <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4235 <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>
4236 control file fields of the package, which declare
4237 dependencies on other packages, the package names listed may
4238 also include lists of alternative package names, separated
4239 by vertical bar (pipe) symbols <tt>|</tt>. In such a case,
4240 if any one of the alternative packages is installed, that
4241 part of the dependency is considered to be satisfied.
4242 </p>
4245 All of the fields except for <tt>Provides</tt> may restrict
4246 their applicability to particular versions of each named
4247 package. This is done in parentheses after each individual
4248 package name; the parentheses should contain a relation from
4249 the list below followed by a version number, in the format
4250 described in <ref id="f-Version">.
4251 </p>
4254 The relations allowed are <tt>&lt;&lt;</tt>, <tt>&lt;=</tt>,
4255 <tt>=</tt>, <tt>&gt;=</tt> and <tt>&gt;&gt;</tt> for
4256 strictly earlier, earlier or equal, exactly equal, later or
4257 equal and strictly later, respectively. The deprecated
4258 forms <tt>&lt;</tt> and <tt>&gt;</tt> were used to mean
4259 earlier/later or equal, rather than strictly earlier/later,
4260 so they should not appear in new packages (though
4261 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> still supports them).
4262 </p>
4265 Whitespace may appear at any point in the version
4266 specification subject to the rules in <ref
4267 id="controlsyntax">, and must appear where it's necessary to
4268 disambiguate; it is not otherwise significant. All of the
4269 relationship fields may span multiple lines. For
4270 consistency and in case of future changes to
4271 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> it is recommended that a single space be
4272 used after a version relationship and before a version
4273 number; it is also conventional to put a single space after
4274 each comma, on either side of each vertical bar, and before
4275 each open parenthesis. When wrapping a relationship field, it
4276 is conventional to do so after a comma and before the space
4277 following that comma.
4278 </p>
4281 For example, a list of dependencies might appear as:
4282 <example compact="compact">
4283 Package: mutt
4284 Version: 1.3.17-1
4285 Depends: libc6 (>= 2.2.1), exim | mail-transport-agent
4286 </example>
4287 </p>
4290 All fields that specify build-time relationships
4291 (<tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4292 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>)
4293 may be restricted to a certain set of architectures. This
4294 is indicated in brackets after each individual package name and
4295 the optional version specification. The brackets enclose a
4296 list of Debian architecture names separated by whitespace.
4297 Exclamation marks may be prepended to each of the names.
4298 (It is not permitted for some names to be prepended with
4299 exclamation marks while others aren't.) If the current Debian
4300 host architecture is not in this list and there are no
4301 exclamation marks in the list, or it is in the list with a
4302 prepended exclamation mark, the package name and the
4303 associated version specification are ignored completely for
4304 the purposes of defining the relationships.
4305 </p>
4308 For example:
4309 <example compact="compact">
4310 Source: glibc
4311 Build-Depends-Indep: texinfo
4312 Build-Depends: kernel-headers-2.2.10 [!hurd-i386],
4313 hurd-dev [hurd-i386], gnumach-dev [hurd-i386]
4314 </example>
4315 requires <tt>kernel-headers-2.2.10</tt> on all architectures
4316 other than hurd-i386 and requires <tt>hurd-dev</tt> and
4317 <tt>gnumach-dev</tt> only on hurd-i386.
4318 </p>
4321 If the architecture-restricted dependency is part of a set of
4322 alternatives using <tt>|</tt>, that alternative is ignored
4323 completely on architectures that do not match the restriction.
4324 For example:
4325 <example compact="compact">
4326 Build-Depends: foo [!i386] | bar [!amd64]
4327 </example>
4328 is equivalent to <tt>bar</tt> on the i386 architecture, to
4329 <tt>foo</tt> on the amd64 architecture, and to <tt>foo |
4330 bar</tt> on all other architectures.
4331 </p>
4334 All fields that specify build-time relationships may also be
4335 restricted to a certain set of architectures using architecture
4336 wildcards. The syntax for declaring such restrictions is the
4337 same as declaring restrictions using a certain set of
4338 architectures without architecture wildcards. For example:
4339 <example compact="compact">
4340 Build-Depends: foo [linux-any], bar [any-i386], baz [!linux-any]
4341 </example>
4342 is equivalent to <tt>foo</tt> on architectures using the Linux
4343 kernel and any cpu, <tt>bar</tt> on architectures using any
4344 kernel and an i386 cpu, and <tt>baz</tt> on any architecture
4345 using a kernel other than Linux.
4346 </p>
4349 Note that the binary package relationship fields such as
4350 <tt>Depends</tt> appear in one of the binary package
4351 sections of the control file, whereas the build-time
4352 relationships such as <tt>Build-Depends</tt> appear in the
4353 source package section of the control file (which is the
4354 first section).
4355 </p>
4356 </sect>
4358 <sect id="binarydeps">
4359 <heading>Binary Dependencies - <tt>Depends</tt>,
4360 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4361 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>
4362 </heading>
4365 Packages can declare in their control file that they have
4366 certain relationships to other packages - for example, that
4367 they may not be installed at the same time as certain other
4368 packages, and/or that they depend on the presence of others.
4369 </p>
4372 This is done using the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4373 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4374 <tt>Breaks</tt> and <tt>Conflicts</tt> control file fields.
4375 <tt>Breaks</tt> is described in <ref id="breaks">, and
4376 <tt>Conflicts</tt> is described in <ref id="conflicts">. The
4377 rest are described below.
4378 </p>
4381 These seven fields are used to declare a dependency
4382 relationship by one package on another. Except for
4383 <tt>Enhances</tt> and <tt>Breaks</tt>, they appear in the
4384 depending (binary) package's control file.
4385 (<tt>Enhances</tt> appears in the recommending package's
4386 control file, and <tt>Breaks</tt> appears in the version of
4387 depended-on package which causes the named package to
4388 break).
4389 </p>
4392 A <tt>Depends</tt> field takes effect <em>only</em> when a
4393 package is to be configured. It does not prevent a package
4394 being on the system in an unconfigured state while its
4395 dependencies are unsatisfied, and it is possible to replace
4396 a package whose dependencies are satisfied and which is
4397 properly installed with a different version whose
4398 dependencies are not and cannot be satisfied; when this is
4399 done the depending package will be left unconfigured (since
4400 attempts to configure it will give errors) and will not
4401 function properly. If it is necessary, a
4402 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field can be used, which has a partial
4403 effect even when a package is being unpacked, as explained
4404 in detail below. (The other three dependency fields,
4405 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt> and
4406 <tt>Enhances</tt>, are only used by the various front-ends
4407 to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> such as <prgn>apt-get</prgn>,
4408 <prgn>aptitude</prgn>, and <prgn>dselect</prgn>.)
4409 </p>
4412 For this reason packages in an installation run are usually
4413 all unpacked first and all configured later; this gives
4414 later versions of packages with dependencies on later
4415 versions of other packages the opportunity to have their
4416 dependencies satisfied.
4417 </p>
4420 In case of circular dependencies, since installation or
4421 removal order honoring the dependency order can't be
4422 established, dependency loops are broken at some point
4423 (based on rules below), and some packages may not be able to
4424 rely on their dependencies being present when being
4425 installed or removed, depending on which side of the break
4426 of the circular dependency loop they happen to be on. If one
4427 of the packages in the loop has no postinst script, then the
4428 cycle will be broken at that package, so as to ensure that
4429 all postinst scripts run with the dependencies properly
4430 configured if this is possible. Otherwise the breaking point
4431 is arbitrary.
4432 </p>
4435 The <tt>Depends</tt> field thus allows package maintainers
4436 to impose an order in which packages should be configured.
4437 </p>
4440 The meaning of the five dependency fields is as follows:
4441 <taglist>
4442 <tag><tt>Depends</tt></tag>
4443 <item>
4445 This declares an absolute dependency. A package will
4446 not be configured unless all of the packages listed in
4447 its <tt>Depends</tt> field have been correctly
4448 configured.
4449 </p>
4452 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should be used if the
4453 depended-on package is required for the depending
4454 package to provide a significant amount of
4455 functionality.
4456 </p>
4459 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should also be used if the
4460 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
4461 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts require the package to be
4462 present in order to run. Note, however, that the
4463 <prgn>postrm</prgn> cannot rely on any non-essential
4464 packages to be present during the <tt>purge</tt>
4465 phase.
4466 </item>
4468 <tag><tt>Recommends</tt></tag>
4469 <item>
4471 This declares a strong, but not absolute, dependency.
4472 </p>
4475 The <tt>Recommends</tt> field should list packages
4476 that would be found together with this one in all but
4477 unusual installations.
4478 </p>
4479 </item>
4481 <tag><tt>Suggests</tt></tag>
4482 <item>
4483 This is used to declare that one package may be more
4484 useful with one or more others. Using this field
4485 tells the packaging system and the user that the
4486 listed packages are related to this one and can
4487 perhaps enhance its usefulness, but that installing
4488 this one without them is perfectly reasonable.
4489 </item>
4491 <tag><tt>Enhances</tt></tag>
4492 <item>
4493 This field is similar to Suggests but works in the
4494 opposite direction. It is used to declare that a
4495 package can enhance the functionality of another
4496 package.
4497 </item>
4499 <tag><tt>Pre-Depends</tt></tag>
4500 <item>
4502 This field is like <tt>Depends</tt>, except that it
4503 also forces <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to complete installation
4504 of the packages named before even starting the
4505 installation of the package which declares the
4506 pre-dependency, as follows:
4507 </p>
4510 When a package declaring a pre-dependency is about to
4511 be <em>unpacked</em> the pre-dependency can be
4512 satisfied if the depended-on package is either fully
4513 configured, <em>or even if</em> the depended-on
4514 package(s) are only unpacked or in the "Half-Configured"
4515 state, provided that they have been configured
4516 correctly at some point in the past (and not removed
4517 or partially removed since). In this case, both the
4518 previously-configured and currently unpacked or
4519 "Half-Configured" versions must satisfy any version
4520 clause in the <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field.
4521 </p>
4524 When the package declaring a pre-dependency is about
4525 to be <em>configured</em>, the pre-dependency will be
4526 treated as a normal <tt>Depends</tt>, that is, it will
4527 be considered satisfied only if the depended-on
4528 package has been correctly configured.
4529 </p>
4532 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> should be used sparingly,
4533 preferably only by packages whose premature upgrade or
4534 installation would hamper the ability of the system to
4535 continue with any upgrade that might be in progress.
4536 </p>
4539 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> are also required if the
4540 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script depends on the named
4541 package. It is best to avoid this situation if
4542 possible.
4543 </p>
4544 </item>
4545 </taglist>
4546 </p>
4549 When selecting which level of dependency to use you should
4550 consider how important the depended-on package is to the
4551 functionality of the one declaring the dependency. Some
4552 packages are composed of components of varying degrees of
4553 importance. Such a package should list using
4554 <tt>Depends</tt> the package(s) which are required by the
4555 more important components. The other components'
4556 requirements may be mentioned as Suggestions or
4557 Recommendations, as appropriate to the components' relative
4558 importance.
4559 </p>
4560 </sect>
4562 <sect id="breaks">
4563 <heading>Packages which break other packages - <tt>Breaks</tt></heading>
4566 When one binary package declares that it breaks another,
4567 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will refuse to allow the package which
4568 declares <tt>Breaks</tt> be installed unless the broken
4569 package is deconfigured first, and it will refuse to
4570 allow the broken package to be reconfigured.
4571 </p>
4574 A package will not be regarded as causing breakage merely
4575 because its configuration files are still installed; it must
4576 be at least "Half-Installed".
4577 </p>
4580 A special exception is made for packages which declare that
4581 they break their own package name or a virtual package which
4582 they provide (see below): this does not count as a real
4583 breakage.
4584 </p>
4587 Normally a <tt>Breaks</tt> entry will have an "earlier than"
4588 version clause; such a <tt>Breaks</tt> is introduced in the
4589 version of an (implicit or explicit) dependency which
4590 violates an assumption or reveals a bug in earlier versions
4591 of the broken package. This use of <tt>Breaks</tt> will
4592 inform higher-level package management tools that broken
4593 package must be upgraded before the new one.
4594 </p>
4597 If the breaking package also overwrites some files from the
4598 older package, it should use <tt>Replaces</tt> (not
4599 <tt>Conflicts</tt>) to ensure this goes smoothly.
4600 </p>
4601 </sect>
4603 <sect id="conflicts">
4604 <heading>Conflicting binary packages - <tt>Conflicts</tt></heading>
4607 When one binary package declares a conflict with another
4608 using a <tt>Conflicts</tt> field, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will
4609 refuse to allow them to be installed on the system at the
4610 same time.
4611 </p>
4614 If one package is to be installed, the other must be removed
4615 first - if the package being installed is marked as
4616 replacing (see <ref id="replaces">) the one on the system,
4617 or the one on the system is marked as deselected, or both
4618 packages are marked <tt>Essential</tt>, then
4619 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will automatically remove the package
4620 which is causing the conflict, otherwise it will halt the
4621 installation of the new package with an error. This
4622 mechanism is specifically designed to produce an error when
4623 the installed package is <tt>Essential</tt>, but the new
4624 package is not.
4625 </p>
4628 A package will not cause a conflict merely because its
4629 configuration files are still installed; it must be at least
4630 "Half-Installed".
4631 </p>
4634 A special exception is made for packages which declare a
4635 conflict with their own package name, or with a virtual
4636 package which they provide (see below): this does not
4637 prevent their installation, and allows a package to conflict
4638 with others providing a replacement for it. You use this
4639 feature when you want the package in question to be the only
4640 package providing some feature.
4641 </p>
4644 A <tt>Conflicts</tt> entry should almost never have an
4645 "earlier than" version clause. This would prevent
4646 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> from upgrading or installing the package
4647 which declared such a conflict until the upgrade or removal
4648 of the conflicted-with package had been completed. Instead,
4649 <tt>Breaks</tt> may be used.
4650 </p>
4651 </sect>
4653 <sect id="virtual"><heading>Virtual packages - <tt>Provides</tt>
4654 </heading>
4657 As well as the names of actual ("concrete") packages, the
4658 package relationship fields <tt>Depends</tt>,
4659 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4660 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
4661 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4662 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
4663 may mention "virtual packages".
4664 </p>
4667 A <em>virtual package</em> is one which appears in the
4668 <tt>Provides</tt> control file field of another package.
4669 The effect is as if the package(s) which provide a
4670 particular virtual package name had been listed by name
4671 everywhere the virtual package name appears. (See also <ref
4672 id="virtual_pkg">)
4673 </p>
4676 If there are both concrete and virtual packages of the same
4677 name, then the dependency may be satisfied (or the conflict
4678 caused) by either the concrete package with the name in
4679 question or any other concrete package which provides the
4680 virtual package with the name in question. This is so that,
4681 for example, supposing we have
4682 <example compact="compact">
4683 Package: foo
4684 Depends: bar
4685 </example> and someone else releases an enhanced version of
4686 the <tt>bar</tt> package they can say:
4687 <example compact="compact">
4688 Package: bar-plus
4689 Provides: bar
4690 </example>
4691 and the <tt>bar-plus</tt> package will now also satisfy the
4692 dependency for the <tt>foo</tt> package.
4693 </p>
4696 If a relationship field has a version number attached
4697 then only real packages will be considered to see whether
4698 the relationship is satisfied (or the prohibition violated,
4699 for a conflict or breakage) - it is assumed that a real
4700 package which provides the virtual package is not of the
4701 "right" version. So, a <tt>Provides</tt> field may not
4702 contain version numbers, and the version number of the
4703 concrete package which provides a particular virtual package
4704 will not be looked at when considering a dependency on or
4705 conflict with the virtual package name.
4706 </p>
4709 It is likely that the ability will be added in a future
4710 release of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to specify a version number for
4711 each virtual package it provides. This feature is not yet
4712 present, however, and is expected to be used only
4713 infrequently.
4714 </p>
4717 If you want to specify which of a set of real packages
4718 should be the default to satisfy a particular dependency on
4719 a virtual package, you should list the real package as an
4720 alternative before the virtual one.
4721 </p>
4722 </sect>
4725 <sect id="replaces"><heading>Overwriting files and replacing
4726 packages - <tt>Replaces</tt></heading>
4729 Packages can declare in their control file that they should
4730 overwrite files in certain other packages, or completely
4731 replace other packages. The <tt>Replaces</tt> control file
4732 field has these two distinct purposes.
4733 </p>
4735 <sect1><heading>Overwriting files in other packages</heading>
4738 Firstly, as mentioned before, it is usually an error for a
4739 package to contain files which are on the system in
4740 another package.
4741 </p>
4744 However, if the overwriting package declares that it
4745 <tt>Replaces</tt> the one containing the file being
4746 overwritten, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will replace the file
4747 from the old package with that from the new. The file
4748 will no longer be listed as "owned" by the old package.
4749 </p>
4752 If a package is completely replaced in this way, so that
4753 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not know of any files it still
4754 contains, it is considered to have "disappeared". It will
4755 be marked as not wanted on the system (selected for
4756 removal) and not installed. Any <tt>conffile</tt>s
4757 details noted for the package will be ignored, as they
4758 will have been taken over by the overwriting package. The
4759 package's <prgn>postrm</prgn> script will be run with a
4760 special argument to allow the package to do any final
4761 cleanup required. See <ref id="mscriptsinstact">.
4762 <footnote>
4764 Replaces is a one way relationship -- you have to
4765 install the replacing package after the replaced
4766 package.
4767 </p>
4768 </footnote>
4769 </p>
4772 For this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt>, virtual packages (see
4773 <ref id="virtual">) are not considered when looking at a
4774 <tt>Replaces</tt> field - the packages declared as being
4775 replaced must be mentioned by their real names.
4776 </p>
4779 Furthermore, this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt> only takes
4780 effect when both packages are at least partially on the
4781 system at once, so that it can only happen if they do not
4782 conflict or if the conflict has been overridden.
4783 </p>
4785 </sect1>
4787 <sect1><heading>Replacing whole packages, forcing their
4788 removal</heading>
4791 Secondly, <tt>Replaces</tt> allows the packaging system to
4792 resolve which package should be removed when there is a
4793 conflict - see <ref id="conflicts">. This usage only
4794 takes effect when the two packages <em>do</em> conflict,
4795 so that the two usages of this field do not interfere with
4796 each other.
4797 </p>
4800 In this situation, the package declared as being replaced
4801 can be a virtual package, so for example, all mail
4802 transport agents (MTAs) would have the following fields in
4803 their control files:
4804 <example compact="compact">
4805 Provides: mail-transport-agent
4806 Conflicts: mail-transport-agent
4807 Replaces: mail-transport-agent
4808 </example>
4809 ensuring that only one MTA can be installed at any one
4810 time.
4811 </sect1>
4812 </sect>
4814 <sect id="sourcebinarydeps">
4815 <heading>Relationships between source and binary packages -
4816 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4817 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
4818 </heading>
4821 Source packages that require certain binary packages to be
4822 installed or absent at the time of building the package
4823 can declare relationships to those binary packages.
4824 </p>
4827 This is done using the <tt>Build-Depends</tt>,
4828 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and
4829 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> control file fields.
4830 </p>
4833 Build-dependencies on "build-essential" binary packages can be
4834 omitted. Please see <ref id="pkg-relations"> for more information.
4835 </p>
4838 The dependencies and conflicts they define must be satisfied
4839 (as defined earlier for binary packages) in order to invoke
4840 the targets in <tt>debian/rules</tt>, as follows:<footnote>
4842 If you make "build-arch" or "binary-arch", you need
4843 Build-Depends. If you make "build-indep" or
4844 "binary-indep", you need Build-Depends and
4845 Build-Depends-Indep. If you make "build" or "binary",
4846 you need both.
4847 </p>
4849 There is no Build-Depends-Arch; this role is essentially
4850 met with Build-Depends. Anyone building the
4851 <tt>build-indep</tt> and binary-indep<tt></tt> targets
4852 is basically assumed to be building the whole package
4853 anyway and so installs all build dependencies. The
4854 autobuilders use <tt>dpkg-buildpackage -B</tt>, which
4855 calls <tt>build</tt> (not <tt>build-arch</tt>, since it
4856 does not yet know how to check for its existence) and
4857 <tt>binary-arch</tt>.
4858 </p>
4860 The purpose of the original split, I recall, was so that
4861 the autobuilders wouldn't need to install extra packages
4862 needed only for the binary-indep targets. But without a
4863 build-arch/build-indep split, this didn't work, since
4864 most of the work is done in the build target, not in the
4865 binary target.
4866 </p>
4867 </footnote>
4869 <taglist>
4870 <tag><tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt></tag>
4871 <item>
4872 The <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and
4873 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> fields must be satisfied when
4874 any of the following targets is invoked:
4875 <tt>build</tt>, <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>binary</tt>,
4876 <tt>binary-arch</tt>, <tt>build-arch</tt>,
4877 <tt>build-indep</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
4878 </item>
4879 <tag><tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4880 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt></tag>
4881 <item>
4882 The <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt> and
4883 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> fields must be
4884 satisfied when any of the following targets is
4885 invoked: <tt>build</tt>, <tt>build-indep</tt>,
4886 <tt>binary</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
4887 </item>
4888 </taglist>
4889 </p>
4891 </sect>
4893 </chapt>
4896 <chapt id="sharedlibs"><heading>Shared libraries</heading>
4899 Packages containing shared libraries must be constructed with
4900 a little care to make sure that the shared library is always
4901 available. This is especially important for packages whose
4902 shared libraries are vitally important, such as the C library
4903 (currently <tt>libc6</tt>).
4904 </p>
4907 Packages involving shared libraries should be split up into
4908 several binary packages. This section mostly deals with how
4909 this separation is to be accomplished; rules for files within
4910 the shared library packages are in <ref id="libraries"> instead.
4911 </p>
4913 <sect id="sharedlibs-runtime">
4914 <heading>Run-time shared libraries</heading>
4917 The run-time shared library needs to be placed in a package
4918 whose name changes whenever the shared object version
4919 changes.<footnote>
4921 Since it is common place to install several versions of a
4922 package that just provides shared libraries, it is a
4923 good idea that the library package should not
4924 contain any extraneous non-versioned files, unless they
4925 happen to be in versioned directories.</p>
4926 </footnote>
4927 The most common mechanism is to place it in a package
4928 called
4929 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var></package>,
4930 where <file><var>soversion</var></file> is the version number
4931 in the soname of the shared library<footnote>
4932 The soname is the shared object name: it's the thing
4933 that has to match exactly between building an executable
4934 and running it for the dynamic linker to be able run the
4935 program. For example, if the soname of the library is
4936 <file>libfoo.so.6</file>, the library package would be
4937 called <file>libfoo6</file>.
4938 </footnote>.
4939 Alternatively, if it would be confusing to directly append
4940 <var>soversion</var> to <var>libraryname</var> (e.g. because
4941 <var>libraryname</var> itself ends in a number), you may use
4942 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var></package> and
4943 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var>-dev</package>
4944 instead.
4945 </p>
4948 If you have several shared libraries built from the same
4949 source tree you may lump them all together into a single
4950 shared library package, provided that you change all of
4951 their sonames at once (so that you don't get filename
4952 clashes if you try to install different versions of the
4953 combined shared libraries package).
4954 </p>
4957 The package should install the shared libraries under
4958 their normal names. For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package>
4959 package should install <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file> as
4960 <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. The files should not be
4961 renamed or re-linked by any <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
4962 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts; <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will take care
4963 of renaming things safely without affecting running programs,
4964 and attempts to interfere with this are likely to lead to
4965 problems.
4966 </p>
4969 Shared libraries should not be installed executable, since
4970 the dynamic linker does not require this and trying to
4971 execute a shared library usually results in a core dump.
4972 </p>
4975 The run-time library package should include the symbolic link that
4976 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> would create for the shared libraries.
4977 For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package> package should include
4978 a symbolic link from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3</file> to
4979 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This is needed so that the dynamic
4980 linker (for example <prgn>ld.so</prgn> or
4981 <prgn>ld-linux.so.*</prgn>) can find the library between the
4982 time that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> installs it and the time that
4983 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> is run in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4984 script.<footnote>
4985 The package management system requires the library to be
4986 placed before the symbolic link pointing to it in the
4987 <file>.deb</file> file. This is so that when
4988 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> comes to install the symlink
4989 (overwriting the previous symlink pointing at an older
4990 version of the library), the new shared library is already
4991 in place. In the past, this was achieved by creating the
4992 library in the temporary packaging directory before
4993 creating the symlink. Unfortunately, this was not always
4994 effective, since the building of the tar file in the
4995 <file>.deb</file> depended on the behavior of the underlying
4996 file system. Some file systems (such as reiserfs) reorder
4997 the files so that the order of creation is forgotten.
4998 Since version 1.7.0, <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
4999 reorders the files itself as necessary when building a
5000 package. Thus it is no longer important to concern
5001 oneself with the order of file creation.
5002 </footnote>
5003 </p>
5005 <sect1 id="ldconfig">
5006 <heading><tt>ldconfig</tt></heading>
5009 Any package installing shared libraries in one of the default
5010 library directories of the dynamic linker (which are currently
5011 <file>/usr/lib</file> and <file>/lib</file>) or a directory that is
5012 listed in <file>/etc/ld.so.conf</file><footnote>
5013 These are currently
5014 <list compact="compact">
5015 <item>/usr/local/lib</item>
5016 <item>/usr/lib/libc5-compat</item>
5017 <item>/lib/libc5-compat</item>
5018 </list>
5019 </footnote>
5020 must use <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> to update the shared library
5021 system.
5022 </p>
5025 The package maintainer scripts must only call
5026 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> under these circumstances:
5027 <list compact="compact">
5028 <item>When the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script is run with a
5029 first argument of <tt>configure</tt>, the script must call
5030 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>, and may optionally invoke
5031 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> at other times.
5032 </item>
5033 <item>When the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script is run with a
5034 first argument of <tt>remove</tt>, the script should call
5035 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>.
5036 </item>
5037 </list>
5038 <footnote>
5040 During install or upgrade, the preinst is called before
5041 the new files are installed, so calling "ldconfig" is
5042 pointless. The preinst of an existing package can also be
5043 called if an upgrade fails. However, this happens during
5044 the critical time when a shared libs may exist on-disk
5045 under a temporary name. Thus, it is dangerous and
5046 forbidden by current policy to call "ldconfig" at this
5047 time.
5048 </p>
5051 When a package is installed or upgraded, "postinst
5052 configure" runs after the new files are safely on-disk.
5053 Since it is perfectly safe to invoke ldconfig
5054 unconditionally in a postinst, it is OK for a package to
5055 simply put ldconfig in its postinst without checking the
5056 argument. The postinst can also be called to recover from
5057 a failed upgrade. This happens before any new files are
5058 unpacked, so there is no reason to call "ldconfig" at this
5059 point.
5060 </p>
5063 For a package that is being removed, prerm is
5064 called with all the files intact, so calling ldconfig is
5065 useless. The other calls to "prerm" happen in the case of
5066 upgrade at a time when all the files of the old package
5067 are on-disk, so again calling "ldconfig" is pointless.
5068 </p>
5071 postrm, on the other hand, is called with the "remove"
5072 argument just after the files are removed, so this is
5073 the proper time to call "ldconfig" to notify the system
5074 of the fact that the shared libraries from the package
5075 are removed. The postrm can be called at several other
5076 times. At the time of "postrm purge", "postrm
5077 abort-install", or "postrm abort-upgrade", calling
5078 "ldconfig" is useless because the shared lib files are
5079 not on-disk. However, when "postrm" is invoked with
5080 arguments "upgrade", "failed-upgrade", or "disappear", a
5081 shared lib may exist on-disk under a temporary filename.
5082 </p>
5083 </footnote>
5084 </p>
5085 </sect1>
5087 </sect>
5089 <sect id="sharedlibs-support-files">
5090 <heading>Shared library support files</heading>
5093 If your package contains files whose names do not change with
5094 each change in the library shared object version, you must not
5095 put them in the shared library package. Otherwise, several
5096 versions of the shared library cannot be installed at the same
5097 time without filename clashes, making upgrades and transitions
5098 unnecessarily difficult.
5099 </p>
5102 It is recommended that supporting files and run-time support
5103 programs that do not need to be invoked manually by users, but
5104 are nevertheless required for the package to function, be placed
5105 (if they are binary) in a subdirectory of <file>/usr/lib</file>,
5106 preferably under <file>/usr/lib/</file><var>package-name</var>.
5107 If the program or file is architecture independent, the
5108 recommendation is for it to be placed in a subdirectory of
5109 <file>/usr/share</file> instead, preferably under
5110 <file>/usr/share/</file><var>package-name</var>. Following the
5111 <var>package-name</var> naming convention ensures that the file
5112 names change when the shared object version changes.
5113 </p>
5116 Run-time support programs that use the shared library but are
5117 not required for the library to function or files used by the
5118 shared library that can be used by any version of the shared
5119 library package should instead be put in a separate package.
5120 This package might typically be named
5121 <package><var>libraryname</var>-tools</package>; note the
5122 absence of the <var>soversion</var> in the package name.
5123 </p>
5126 Files and support programs only useful when compiling software
5127 against the library should be included in the development
5128 package for the library.<footnote>
5129 For example, a <file><var>package-name</var>-config</file>
5130 script or <package>pkg-config</package> configuration files.
5131 </footnote>
5132 </p>
5133 </sect>
5135 <sect id="sharedlibs-static">
5136 <heading>Static libraries</heading>
5139 The static library (<file><var>libraryname.a</var></file>)
5140 is usually provided in addition to the shared version.
5141 It is placed into the development package (see below).
5142 </p>
5145 In some cases, it is acceptable for a library to be
5146 available in static form only; these cases include:
5147 <list>
5148 <item>libraries for languages whose shared library support
5149 is immature or unstable</item>
5150 <item>libraries whose interfaces are in flux or under
5151 development (commonly the case when the library's
5152 major version number is zero, or where the ABI breaks
5153 across patchlevels)</item>
5154 <item>libraries which are explicitly intended to be
5155 available only in static form by their upstream
5156 author(s)</item>
5157 </list>
5158 </p>
5160 <sect id="sharedlibs-dev">
5161 <heading>Development files</heading>
5164 The development files associated to a shared library need to be
5165 placed in a package called
5166 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var>-dev</package>,
5167 or if you prefer only to support one development version at a
5168 time, <package><var>libraryname</var>-dev</package>.
5169 </p>
5172 In case several development versions of a library exist, you may
5173 need to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s Conflicts mechanism (see
5174 <ref id="conflicts">) to ensure that the user only installs one
5175 development version at a time (as different development versions are
5176 likely to have the same header files in them, which would cause a
5177 filename clash if both were installed).
5178 </p>
5181 The development package should contain a symlink for the associated
5182 shared library without a version number. For example, the
5183 <package>libgdbm-dev</package> package should include a symlink
5184 from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so</file> to
5185 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This symlink is needed by the linker
5186 (<prgn>ld</prgn>) when compiling packages, as it will only look for
5187 <file>libgdbm.so</file> when compiling dynamically.
5188 </p>
5189 </sect>
5191 <sect id="sharedlibs-intradeps">
5192 <heading>Dependencies between the packages of the same library</heading>
5195 Typically the development version should have an exact
5196 version dependency on the runtime library, to make sure that
5197 compilation and linking happens correctly. The
5198 <tt>${binary:Version}</tt> substitution variable can be
5199 useful for this purpose.
5200 <footnote>
5201 Previously, <tt>${Source-Version}</tt> was used, but its name
5202 was confusing and it has been deprecated since dpkg 1.13.19.
5203 </footnote>
5204 </p>
5205 </sect>
5207 <sect id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">
5208 <heading>Dependencies between the library and other packages -
5209 the <tt>shlibs</tt> system</heading>
5212 If a package contains a binary or library which links to a
5213 shared library, we must ensure that when the package is
5214 installed on the system, all of the libraries needed are
5215 also installed. This requirement led to the creation of the
5216 <tt>shlibs</tt> system, which is very simple in its design:
5217 any package which <em>provides</em> a shared library also
5218 provides information on the package dependencies required to
5219 ensure the presence of this library, and any package which
5220 <em>uses</em> a shared library uses this information to
5221 determine the dependencies it requires. The files which
5222 contain the mapping from shared libraries to the necessary
5223 dependency information are called <file>shlibs</file> files.
5224 </p>
5227 Thus, when a package is built which contains any shared
5228 libraries, it must provide a <file>shlibs</file> file for other
5229 packages to use, and when a package is built which contains
5230 any shared libraries or compiled binaries, it must run
5231 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5232 on these to determine the libraries used and hence the
5233 dependencies needed by this package.<footnote>
5235 In the past, the shared libraries linked to were
5236 determined by calling <prgn>ldd</prgn>, but now
5237 <prgn>objdump</prgn> is used to do this. The only
5238 change this makes to package building is that
5239 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must also be run on shared
5240 libraries, whereas in the past this was unnecessary.
5241 The rest of this footnote explains the advantage that
5242 this method gives.
5243 </p>
5246 We say that a binary <tt>foo</tt> <em>directly</em> uses
5247 a library <tt>libbar</tt> if it is explicitly linked
5248 with that library (that is, it uses the flag
5249 <tt>-lbar</tt> during the linking stage). Other
5250 libraries that are needed by <tt>libbar</tt> are linked
5251 <em>indirectly</em> to <tt>foo</tt>, and the dynamic
5252 linker will load them automatically when it loads
5253 <tt>libbar</tt>. A package should depend on
5254 the libraries it directly uses, and the dependencies for
5255 those libraries should automatically pull in the other
5256 libraries.
5257 </p>
5260 Unfortunately, the <prgn>ldd</prgn> program shows both
5261 the directly and indirectly used libraries, meaning that
5262 the dependencies determined included both direct and
5263 indirect dependencies. The use of <prgn>objdump</prgn>
5264 avoids this problem by determining only the directly
5265 used libraries.
5266 </p>
5269 A good example of where this helps is the following. We
5270 could update <tt>libimlib</tt> with a new version that
5271 supports a new graphics format called dgf (but retaining
5272 the same major version number). If we used the old
5273 <prgn>ldd</prgn> method, every package that uses
5274 <tt>libimlib</tt> would need to be recompiled so it
5275 would also depend on <tt>libdgf</tt> or it wouldn't run
5276 due to missing symbols. However with the new system,
5277 packages using <tt>libimlib</tt> can rely on
5278 <tt>libimlib</tt> itself having the dependency on
5279 <tt>libdgf</tt> and so they would not need rebuilding.
5280 </p>
5281 </footnote>
5282 </p>
5285 In the following sections, we will first describe where the
5286 various <tt>shlibs</tt> files are to be found, then how to
5287 use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>, and finally the <tt>shlibs</tt>
5288 file format and how to create them if your package contains a
5289 shared library.
5290 </p>
5292 <sect1>
5293 <heading>The <tt>shlibs</tt> files present on the system</heading>
5296 There are several places where <tt>shlibs</tt> files are
5297 found. The following list gives them in the order in which
5298 they are read by
5299 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>.
5300 (The first one which gives the required information is used.)
5301 </p>
5304 <list>
5305 <item>
5306 <p><file>debian/shlibs.local</file></p>
5309 This lists overrides for this package. Its use is
5310 described below (see <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5311 </p>
5312 </item>
5314 <item>
5315 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.override</file></p>
5318 This lists global overrides. This list is normally
5319 empty. It is maintained by the local system
5320 administrator.
5321 </p>
5322 </item>
5324 <item>
5325 <p><file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in the "build directory"</p>
5328 When packages are being built, any
5329 <file>debian/shlibs</file> files are copied into the
5330 control file area of the temporary build directory and
5331 given the name <file>shlibs</file>. These files give
5332 details of any shared libraries included in the
5333 package.<footnote>
5334 An example may help here. Let us say that the
5335 source package <tt>foo</tt> generates two binary
5336 packages, <tt>libfoo2</tt> and
5337 <tt>foo-runtime</tt>. When building the binary
5338 packages, the two packages are created in the
5339 directories <file>debian/libfoo2</file> and
5340 <file>debian/foo-runtime</file> respectively.
5341 (<file>debian/tmp</file> could be used instead of one
5342 of these.) Since <tt>libfoo2</tt> provides the
5343 <tt>libfoo</tt> shared library, it will require a
5344 <tt>shlibs</tt> file, which will be installed in
5345 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file>, eventually
5346 to become
5347 <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/libfoo2.shlibs</file>. Then
5348 when <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is run on the
5349 executable
5350 <file>debian/foo-runtime/usr/bin/foo-prog</file>, it
5351 will examine the
5352 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file> file to
5353 determine whether <tt>foo-prog</tt>'s library
5354 dependencies are satisfied by any of the libraries
5355 provided by <tt>libfoo2</tt>. For this reason,
5356 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must only be run once
5357 all of the individual binary packages'
5358 <tt>shlibs</tt> files have been installed into the
5359 build directory.
5360 </footnote>
5361 </p>
5362 </item>
5364 <item>
5365 <p><file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.shlibs</file></p>
5368 These are the <file>shlibs</file> files corresponding to
5369 all of the packages installed on the system, and are
5370 maintained by the relevant package maintainers.
5371 </p>
5372 </item>
5374 <item>
5375 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.default</file></p>
5378 This file lists any shared libraries whose packages
5379 have failed to provide correct <file>shlibs</file> files.
5380 It was used when the <file>shlibs</file> setup was first
5381 introduced, but it is now normally empty. It is
5382 maintained by the <tt>dpkg</tt> maintainer.
5383 </p>
5384 </item>
5385 </list>
5386 </p>
5387 </sect1>
5389 <sect1>
5390 <heading>How to use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> and the
5391 <file>shlibs</file> files</heading>
5394 Put a call to
5395 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5396 into your <file>debian/rules</file> file. If your package
5397 contains only compiled binaries and libraries (but no scripts),
5398 you can use a command such as:
5399 <example compact="compact">
5400 dpkg-shlibdeps debian/tmp/usr/bin/* debian/tmp/usr/sbin/* \
5401 debian/tmp/usr/lib/*
5402 </example>
5403 Otherwise, you will need to explicitly list the compiled
5404 binaries and libraries.<footnote>
5405 If you are using <tt>debhelper</tt>, the
5406 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> program will do this work for
5407 you. It will also correctly handle multi-binary
5408 packages.
5409 </footnote>
5410 </p>
5413 This command puts the dependency information into the
5414 <file>debian/substvars</file> file, which is then used by
5415 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>. You will need to place a
5416 <tt>${shlibs:Depends}</tt> variable in the <tt>Depends</tt>
5417 field in the control file for this to work.
5418 </p>
5421 If <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> doesn't complain, you're
5422 done. If it does complain you might need to create your own
5423 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file, as explained below (see
5424 <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5425 </p>
5428 If you have multiple binary packages, you will need to call
5429 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> on each one which contains
5430 compiled libraries or binaries. In such a case, you will
5431 need to use the <tt>-T</tt> option to the <tt>dpkg</tt>
5432 utilities to specify a different <file>substvars</file> file.
5433 </p>
5436 If you are creating a udeb for use in the Debian Installer,
5437 you will need to specify that <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
5438 should use the dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt> by
5439 adding the <tt>-tudeb</tt> option<footnote>
5440 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> from the <tt>debhelper</tt> suite
5441 will automatically add this option if it knows it is
5442 processing a udeb.
5443 </footnote>. If there is no dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt>
5444 in the <file>shlibs</file> file, <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will
5445 fall back to the regular dependency line.
5446 </p>
5449 For more details on dpkg-shlibdeps, please see
5450 <ref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"> and
5451 <manref name="dpkg-shlibdeps" section="1">.
5452 </p>
5453 </sect1>
5455 <sect1 id="shlibs">
5456 <heading>The <file>shlibs</file> File Format</heading>
5459 Each <file>shlibs</file> file has the same format. Lines
5460 beginning with <tt>#</tt> are considered to be comments and
5461 are ignored. Each line is of the form:
5462 <example compact="compact">
5463 [<var>type</var>: ]<var>library-name</var> <var>soname-version</var> <var>dependencies ...</var>
5464 </example>
5465 </p>
5468 We will explain this by reference to the example of the
5469 <tt>zlib1g</tt> package, which (at the time of writing)
5470 installs the shared library <file>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3</file>.
5471 </p>
5474 <var>type</var> is an optional element that indicates the type
5475 of package for which the line is valid. The only type currently
5476 in use is <tt>udeb</tt>. The colon and space after the type are
5477 required.
5478 </p>
5481 <var>library-name</var> is the name of the shared library,
5482 in this case <tt>libz</tt>. (This must match the name part
5483 of the soname, see below.)
5484 </p>
5487 <var>soname-version</var> is the version part of the soname of
5488 the library. The soname is the thing that must exactly match
5489 for the library to be recognized by the dynamic linker, and is
5490 usually of the form
5491 <tt><var>name</var>.so.<var>major-version</var></tt>, in our
5492 example, <tt>libz.so.1</tt>.<footnote>
5493 This can be determined using the command
5494 <example compact="compact">
5495 objdump -p /usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3 | grep SONAME
5496 </example>
5497 </footnote>
5498 The version part is the part which comes after
5499 <tt>.so.</tt>, so in our case, it is <tt>1</tt>.
5500 </p>
5503 <var>dependencies</var> has the same syntax as a dependency
5504 field in a binary package control file. It should give
5505 details of which packages are required to satisfy a binary
5506 built against the version of the library contained in the
5507 package. See <ref id="depsyntax"> for details.
5508 </p>
5511 In our example, if the first version of the <tt>zlib1g</tt>
5512 package which contained a minor number of at least
5513 <tt>1.3</tt> was <var>1:1.1.3-1</var>, then the
5514 <tt>shlibs</tt> entry for this library could say:
5515 <example compact="compact">
5516 libz 1 zlib1g (>= 1:1.1.3)
5517 </example>
5518 The version-specific dependency is to avoid warnings from
5519 the dynamic linker about using older shared libraries with
5520 newer binaries.
5521 </p>
5524 As zlib1g also provides a udeb containing the shared library,
5525 there would also be a second line:
5526 <example compact="compact">
5527 udeb: libz 1 zlib1g-udeb (>= 1:1.1.3)
5528 </example>
5529 </p>
5530 </sect1>
5532 <sect1>
5533 <heading>Providing a <file>shlibs</file> file</heading>
5536 If your package provides a shared library, you need to create
5537 a <file>shlibs</file> file following the format described above.
5538 It is usual to call this file <file>debian/shlibs</file> (but if
5539 you have multiple binary packages, you might want to call it
5540 <file>debian/shlibs.<var>package</var></file> instead). Then
5541 let <file>debian/rules</file> install it in the control area:
5542 <example compact="compact">
5543 install -m644 debian/shlibs debian/tmp/DEBIAN
5544 </example>
5545 or, in the case of a multi-binary package:
5546 <example compact="compact">
5547 install -m644 debian/shlibs.<var>package</var> debian/<var>package</var>/DEBIAN/shlibs
5548 </example>
5549 An alternative way of doing this is to create the
5550 <file>shlibs</file> file in the control area directly from
5551 <file>debian/rules</file> without using a <file>debian/shlibs</file>
5552 file at all,<footnote>
5553 This is what <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> in the
5554 <tt>debhelper</tt> suite does. If your package also has a udeb
5555 that provides a shared library, <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> can
5556 automatically generate the <tt>udeb:</tt> lines if you specify
5557 the name of the udeb with the <tt>--add-udeb</tt> option.
5558 </footnote>
5559 since the <file>debian/shlibs</file> file itself is ignored by
5560 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
5561 </p>
5564 As <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> reads the
5565 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in all of the binary packages
5566 being built from this source package, all of the
5567 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files should be installed before
5568 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is called on any of the binary
5569 packages.
5570 </p>
5571 </sect1>
5573 <sect1 id="shlibslocal">
5574 <heading>Writing the <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file</heading>
5577 This file is intended only as a <em>temporary</em> fix if
5578 your binaries or libraries depend on a library whose package
5579 does not yet provide a correct <file>shlibs</file> file.
5580 </p>
5583 We will assume that you are trying to package a binary
5584 <tt>foo</tt>. When you try running
5585 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> you get the following error
5586 message (<tt>-O</tt> displays the dependency information on
5587 <tt>stdout</tt> instead of writing it to
5588 <tt>debian/substvars</tt>, and the lines have been wrapped
5589 for ease of reading):
5590 <example compact="compact">
5591 $ dpkg-shlibdeps -O debian/tmp/usr/bin/foo
5592 dpkg-shlibdeps: warning: unable to find dependency
5593 information for shared library libbar (soname 1,
5594 path /usr/lib/libbar.so.1, dependency field Depends)
5595 shlibs:Depends=libc6 (>= 2.2.2-2)
5596 </example>
5597 You can then run <prgn>ldd</prgn> on the binary to find the
5598 full location of the library concerned:
5599 <example compact="compact">
5600 $ ldd foo
5601 libbar.so.1 => /usr/lib/libbar.so.1 (0x4001e000)
5602 libc.so.6 => /lib/libc.so.6 (0x40032000)
5603 /lib/ld-linux.so.2 => /lib/ld-linux.so.2 (0x40000000)
5604 </example>
5605 So the <prgn>foo</prgn> binary depends on the
5606 <prgn>libbar</prgn> shared library, but no package seems to
5607 provide a <file>*.shlibs</file> file handling
5608 <file>libbar.so.1</file> in <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/</file>. Let's
5609 determine the package responsible:
5610 <example compact="compact">
5611 $ dpkg -S /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5612 bar1: /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5613 $ dpkg -s bar1 | grep Version
5614 Version: 1.0-1
5615 </example>
5616 This tells us that the <tt>bar1</tt> package, version 1.0-1,
5617 is the one we are using. Now we can file a bug against the
5618 <tt>bar1</tt> package and create our own
5619 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> to locally fix the problem.
5620 Including the following line into your
5621 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file:
5622 <example compact="compact">
5623 libbar 1 bar1 (>= 1.0-1)
5624 </example>
5625 should allow the package build to work.
5626 </p>
5629 As soon as the maintainer of <tt>bar1</tt> provides a
5630 correct <file>shlibs</file> file, you should remove this line
5631 from your <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file. (You should
5632 probably also then have a versioned <tt>Build-Depends</tt>
5633 on <tt>bar1</tt> to help ensure that others do not have the
5634 same problem building your package.)
5635 </p>
5636 </sect1>
5638 </sect>
5640 </chapt>
5643 <chapt id="opersys"><heading>The Operating System</heading>
5645 <sect>
5646 <heading>File system hierarchy</heading>
5649 <sect1 id="fhs">
5650 <heading>File System Structure</heading>
5653 The location of all installed files and directories must
5654 comply with the Filesystem Hierarchy Standard (FHS),
5655 version 2.3, with the exceptions noted below, and except
5656 where doing so would violate other terms of Debian
5657 Policy. The following exceptions to the FHS apply:
5659 <enumlist>
5660 <item>
5662 The optional rules related to user specific
5663 configuration files for applications are stored in
5664 the user's home directory are relaxed. It is
5665 recommended that such files start with the
5666 '<tt>.</tt>' character (a "dot file"), and if an
5667 application needs to create more than one dot file
5668 then the preferred placement is in a subdirectory
5669 with a name starting with a '.' character, (a "dot
5670 directory"). In this case it is recommended the
5671 configuration files not start with the '.'
5672 character.
5673 </p>
5674 </item>
5675 <item>
5677 The requirement for amd64 to use <file>/lib64</file>
5678 for 64 bit binaries is removed.
5679 </p>
5680 </item>
5681 <item>
5683 The requirement for object files, internal binaries, and
5684 libraries, including <file>libc.so.*</file>, to be located
5685 directly under <file>/lib{,32}</file> and
5686 <file>/usr/lib{,32}</file> is amended, permitting files
5687 to instead be installed to
5688 <file>/lib/<var>triplet</var></file> and
5689 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>, where
5690 <tt><var>triplet</var></tt> is the value returned by
5691 <tt>dpkg-architecture -qDEB_HOST_GNU_TYPE</tt> for the
5692 architecture of the package. Packages may <em>not</em>
5693 install files to any <var>triplet</var> path other
5694 than the one matching the architecture of that package;
5695 for instance, an <tt>Architecture: amd64</tt> package
5696 containing 32-bit x86 libraries may not install these
5697 libraries to <file>/usr/lib/i486-linux-gnu</file>.
5698 <footnote>
5699 This is necessary in order to reserve the directories for
5700 use in cross-installation of library packages from other
5701 architectures, as part of the planned deployment of
5702 <tt>multiarch</tt>.
5703 </footnote>
5704 </p>
5706 Applications may also use a single subdirectory under
5707 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>.
5708 </p>
5710 The execution time linker/loader, ld*, must still be made
5711 available in the existing location under /lib or /lib64
5712 since this is part of the ELF ABI for the architecture.
5713 </p>
5714 </item>
5715 <item>
5717 The requirement that
5718 <file>/usr/local/share/man</file> be "synonymous"
5719 with <file>/usr/local/man</file> is relaxed to a
5720 recommendation</p>
5721 </item>
5722 <item>
5724 The requirement that windowmanagers with a single
5725 configuration file call it <file>system.*wmrc</file>
5726 is removed, as is the restriction that the window
5727 manager subdirectory be named identically to the
5728 window manager name itself.
5729 </p>
5730 </item>
5731 <item>
5733 The requirement that boot manager configuration
5734 files live in <file>/etc</file>, or at least are
5735 symlinked there, is relaxed to a recommendation.
5736 </p>
5737 </item>
5738 <item>
5740 The following directories in the root filesystem are
5741 additionally allowed: <file>/sys</file> and
5742 <file>/selinux</file>. <footnote>These directories
5743 are used as mount points to mount virtual filesystems
5744 to get access to kernel information.</footnote>
5745 </p>
5746 </item>
5747 </enumlist>
5749 </p>
5751 The version of this document referred here can be
5752 found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package or on <url
5753 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/fhs/"
5754 name="FHS (Debian copy)"> alongside this manual (or, if
5755 you have the <package>debian-policy</package> installed,
5756 you can try <url
5757 id="file:///usr/share/doc/debian-policy/fhs/" name="FHS
5758 (local copy)">). The
5759 latest version, which may be a more recent version, may
5760 be found on
5761 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS (upstream)">.
5762 Specific questions about following the standard may be
5763 asked on the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list, or
5764 referred to the FHS mailing list (see the
5765 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS web site"> for
5766 more information).
5767 </p>
5768 </sect1>
5770 <sect1>
5771 <heading>Site-specific programs</heading>
5774 As mandated by the FHS, packages must not place any
5775 files in <file>/usr/local</file>, either by putting them in
5776 the file system archive to be unpacked by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5777 or by manipulating them in their maintainer scripts.
5778 </p>
5781 However, the package may create empty directories below
5782 <file>/usr/local</file> so that the system administrator knows
5783 where to place site-specific files. These are not
5784 directories <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>, but are
5785 children of directories in <file>/usr/local</file>. These
5786 directories (<file>/usr/local/*/dir/</file>)
5787 should be removed on package removal if they are
5788 empty.
5789 </p>
5792 Note that this applies only to
5793 directories <em>below</em> <file>/usr/local</file>,
5794 not <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>. Packages must
5795 not create sub-directories in the
5796 directory <file>/usr/local</file> itself, except those
5797 listed in FHS, section 4.5. However, you may create
5798 directories below them as you wish. You must not remove
5799 any of the directories listed in 4.5, even if you created
5800 them.
5801 </p>
5804 Since <file>/usr/local</file> can be mounted read-only from a
5805 remote server, these directories must be created and
5806 removed by the <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>prerm</prgn>
5807 maintainer scripts and not be included in the
5808 <file>.deb</file> archive. These scripts must not fail if
5809 either of these operations fail.
5810 </p>
5813 For example, the <tt>emacsen-common</tt> package could
5814 contain something like
5815 <example compact="compact">
5816 if [ ! -e /usr/local/share/emacs ]
5817 then
5818 if mkdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null
5819 then
5820 chown root:staff /usr/local/share/emacs
5821 chmod 2775 /usr/local/share/emacs
5824 </example>
5825 in its <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and
5826 <example compact="compact">
5827 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp 2>/dev/null || true
5828 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null || true
5829 </example>
5830 in the <prgn>prerm</prgn> script. (Note that this form is
5831 used to ensure that if the script is interrupted, the
5832 directory <file>/usr/local/share/emacs</file> will still be
5833 removed.)
5834 </p>
5837 If you do create a directory in <file>/usr/local</file> for
5838 local additions to a package, you should ensure that
5839 settings in <file>/usr/local</file> take precedence over the
5840 equivalents in <file>/usr</file>.
5841 </p>
5844 However, because <file>/usr/local</file> and its contents are
5845 for exclusive use of the local administrator, a package
5846 must not rely on the presence or absence of files or
5847 directories in <file>/usr/local</file> for normal operation.
5848 </p>
5851 The <file>/usr/local</file> directory itself and all the
5852 subdirectories created by the package should (by default) have
5853 permissions 2775 (group-writable and set-group-id) and be
5854 owned by <tt>root:staff</tt>.
5855 </p>
5856 </sect1>
5858 <sect1>
5859 <heading>The system-wide mail directory</heading>
5861 The system-wide mail directory
5862 is <file>/var/mail</file>. This directory is part of the
5863 base system and should not be owned by any particular mail
5864 agents. The use of the old
5865 location <file>/var/spool/mail</file> is deprecated, even
5866 though the spool may still be physically located there.
5867 </p>
5868 </sect1>
5869 </sect>
5871 <sect>
5872 <heading>Users and groups</heading>
5874 <sect1>
5875 <heading>Introduction</heading>
5877 The Debian system can be configured to use either plain or
5878 shadow passwords.
5879 </p>
5882 Some user ids (UIDs) and group ids (GIDs) are reserved
5883 globally for use by certain packages. Because some
5884 packages need to include files which are owned by these
5885 users or groups, or need the ids compiled into binaries,
5886 these ids must be used on any Debian system only for the
5887 purpose for which they are allocated. This is a serious
5888 restriction, and we should avoid getting in the way of
5889 local administration policies. In particular, many sites
5890 allocate users and/or local system groups starting at 100.
5891 </p>
5894 Apart from this we should have dynamically allocated ids,
5895 which should by default be arranged in some sensible
5896 order, but the behavior should be configurable.
5897 </p>
5900 Packages other than <tt>base-passwd</tt> must not modify
5901 <file>/etc/passwd</file>, <file>/etc/shadow</file>,
5902 <file>/etc/group</file> or <file>/etc/gshadow</file>.
5903 </p>
5904 </sect1>
5906 <sect1>
5907 <heading>UID and GID classes</heading>
5909 The UID and GID numbers are divided into classes as
5910 follows:
5911 <taglist>
5912 <tag>0-99:</tag>
5913 <item>
5915 Globally allocated by the Debian project, the same
5916 on every Debian system. These ids will appear in
5917 the <file>passwd</file> and <file>group</file> files of all
5918 Debian systems, new ids in this range being added
5919 automatically as the <tt>base-passwd</tt> package is
5920 updated.
5921 </p>
5924 Packages which need a single statically allocated
5925 uid or gid should use one of these; their
5926 maintainers should ask the <tt>base-passwd</tt>
5927 maintainer for ids.
5928 </p>
5929 </item>
5931 <tag>100-999:</tag>
5932 <item>
5934 Dynamically allocated system users and groups.
5935 Packages which need a user or group, but can have
5936 this user or group allocated dynamically and
5937 differently on each system, should use <tt>adduser
5938 --system</tt> to create the group and/or user.
5939 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will check for the existence of
5940 the user or group, and if necessary choose an unused
5941 id based on the ranges specified in
5942 <file>adduser.conf</file>.
5943 </p>
5944 </item>
5946 <tag>1000-59999:</tag>
5947 <item>
5949 Dynamically allocated user accounts. By default
5950 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will choose UIDs and GIDs for
5951 user accounts in this range, though
5952 <file>adduser.conf</file> may be used to modify this
5953 behavior.
5954 </p>
5955 </item>
5957 <tag>60000-64999:</tag>
5958 <item>
5960 Globally allocated by the Debian project, but only
5961 created on demand. The ids are allocated centrally
5962 and statically, but the actual accounts are only
5963 created on users' systems on demand.
5964 </p>
5967 These ids are for packages which are obscure or
5968 which require many statically-allocated ids. These
5969 packages should check for and create the accounts in
5970 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file> (using
5971 <prgn>adduser</prgn> if it has this facility) if
5972 necessary. Packages which are likely to require
5973 further allocations should have a "hole" left after
5974 them in the allocation, to give them room to
5975 grow.
5976 </p>
5977 </item>
5979 <tag>65000-65533:</tag>
5980 <item>
5981 <p>Reserved.</p>
5982 </item>
5984 <tag>65534:</tag>
5985 <item>
5987 User <tt>nobody</tt>. The corresponding gid refers
5988 to the group <tt>nogroup</tt>.
5989 </p>
5990 </item>
5992 <tag>65535:</tag>
5993 <item>
5995 <tt>(uid_t)(-1) == (gid_t)(-1)</tt> <em>must
5996 not</em> be used, because it is the error return
5997 sentinel value.
5998 </p>
5999 </item>
6000 </taglist>
6001 </p>
6002 </sect1>
6003 </sect>
6005 <sect id="sysvinit">
6006 <heading>System run levels and <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6008 <sect1 id="/etc/init.d">
6009 <heading>Introduction</heading>
6012 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> directory contains the scripts
6013 executed by <prgn>init</prgn> at boot time and when the
6014 init state (or "runlevel") is changed (see <manref
6015 name="init" section="8">).
6016 </p>
6019 There are at least two different, yet functionally
6020 equivalent, ways of handling these scripts. For the sake
6021 of simplicity, this document describes only the symbolic
6022 link method. However, it must not be assumed by maintainer
6023 scripts that this method is being used, and any automated
6024 manipulation of the various runlevel behaviors by
6025 maintainer scripts must be performed using
6026 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> as described below and not by
6027 manually installing or removing symlinks. For information
6028 on the implementation details of the other method,
6029 implemented in the <tt>file-rc</tt> package, please refer
6030 to the documentation of that package.
6031 </p>
6034 These scripts are referenced by symbolic links in the
6035 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories. When changing
6036 runlevels, <prgn>init</prgn> looks in the directory
6037 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> for the scripts it should
6038 execute, where <tt><var>n</var></tt> is the runlevel that
6039 is being changed to, or <tt>S</tt> for the boot-up
6040 scripts.
6041 </p>
6044 The names of the links all have the form
6045 <file>S<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> or
6046 <file>K<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> where
6047 <var>mm</var> is a two-digit number and <var>script</var>
6048 is the name of the script (this should be the same as the
6049 name of the actual script in <file>/etc/init.d</file>).
6050 </p>
6053 When <prgn>init</prgn> changes runlevel first the targets
6054 of the links whose names start with a <tt>K</tt> are
6055 executed, each with the single argument <tt>stop</tt>,
6056 followed by the scripts prefixed with an <tt>S</tt>, each
6057 with the single argument <tt>start</tt>. (The links are
6058 those in the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directory
6059 corresponding to the new runlevel.) The <tt>K</tt> links
6060 are responsible for killing services and the <tt>S</tt>
6061 link for starting services upon entering the runlevel.
6062 </p>
6065 For example, if we are changing from runlevel 2 to
6066 runlevel 3, init will first execute all of the <tt>K</tt>
6067 prefixed scripts it finds in <file>/etc/rc3.d</file>, and then
6068 all of the <tt>S</tt> prefixed scripts in that directory.
6069 The links starting with <tt>K</tt> will cause the
6070 referred-to file to be executed with an argument of
6071 <tt>stop</tt>, and the <tt>S</tt> links with an argument
6072 of <tt>start</tt>.
6073 </p>
6076 The two-digit number <var>mm</var> is used to determine
6077 the order in which to run the scripts: low-numbered links
6078 have their scripts run first. For example, the
6079 <tt>K20</tt> scripts will be executed before the
6080 <tt>K30</tt> scripts. This is used when a certain service
6081 must be started before another. For example, the name
6082 server <prgn>bind</prgn> might need to be started before
6083 the news server <prgn>inn</prgn> so that <prgn>inn</prgn>
6084 can set up its access lists. In this case, the script
6085 that starts <prgn>bind</prgn> would have a lower number
6086 than the script that starts <prgn>inn</prgn> so that it
6087 runs first:
6088 <example compact="compact">
6089 /etc/rc2.d/S17bind
6090 /etc/rc2.d/S70inn
6091 </example>
6092 </p>
6095 The two runlevels 0 (halt) and 6 (reboot) are slightly
6096 different. In these runlevels, the links with an
6097 <tt>S</tt> prefix are still called after those with a
6098 <tt>K</tt> prefix, but they too are called with the single
6099 argument <tt>stop</tt>.
6100 </p>
6101 </sect1>
6103 <sect1 id="writing-init">
6104 <heading>Writing the scripts</heading>
6107 Packages that include daemons for system services should
6108 place scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file> to start or stop
6109 services at boot time or during a change of runlevel.
6110 These scripts should be named
6111 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file>, and they should
6112 accept one argument, saying what to do:
6114 <taglist>
6115 <tag><tt>start</tt></tag>
6116 <item>start the service,</item>
6118 <tag><tt>stop</tt></tag>
6119 <item>stop the service,</item>
6121 <tag><tt>restart</tt></tag>
6122 <item>stop and restart the service if it's already running,
6123 otherwise start the service</item>
6125 <tag><tt>reload</tt></tag>
6126 <item><p>cause the configuration of the service to be
6127 reloaded without actually stopping and restarting
6128 the service,</item>
6130 <tag><tt>force-reload</tt></tag>
6131 <item>cause the configuration to be reloaded if the
6132 service supports this, otherwise restart the
6133 service.</item>
6134 </taglist>
6136 The <tt>start</tt>, <tt>stop</tt>, <tt>restart</tt>, and
6137 <tt>force-reload</tt> options should be supported by all
6138 scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file>, the <tt>reload</tt>
6139 option is optional.
6140 </p>
6143 The <file>init.d</file> scripts must ensure that they will
6144 behave sensibly (i.e., returning success and not starting
6145 multiple copies of a service) if invoked with <tt>start</tt>
6146 when the service is already running, or with <tt>stop</tt>
6147 when it isn't, and that they don't kill unfortunately-named
6148 user processes. The best way to achieve this is usually to
6149 use <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn> with the <tt>--oknodo</tt>
6150 option.
6151 </p>
6154 Be careful of using <tt>set -e</tt> in <file>init.d</file>
6155 scripts. Writing correct <file>init.d</file> scripts requires
6156 accepting various error exit statuses when daemons are already
6157 running or already stopped without aborting
6158 the <file>init.d</file> script, and common <file>init.d</file>
6159 function libraries are not safe to call with <tt>set -e</tt>
6160 in effect<footnote>
6161 <tt>/lib/lsb/init-functions</tt>, which assists in writing
6162 LSB-compliant init scripts, may fail if <tt>set -e</tt> is
6163 in effect and echoing status messages to the console fails,
6164 for example.
6165 </footnote>. For <tt>init.d</tt> scripts, it's often easier
6166 to not use <tt>set -e</tt> and instead check the result of
6167 each command separately.
6168 </p>
6171 If a service reloads its configuration automatically (as
6172 in the case of <prgn>cron</prgn>, for example), the
6173 <tt>reload</tt> option of the <file>init.d</file> script
6174 should behave as if the configuration has been reloaded
6175 successfully.
6176 </p>
6179 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts must be treated as
6180 configuration files, either (if they are present in the
6181 package, that is, in the .deb file) by marking them as
6182 <tt>conffile</tt>s, or, (if they do not exist in the .deb)
6183 by managing them correctly in the maintainer scripts (see
6184 <ref id="config-files">). This is important since we want
6185 to give the local system administrator the chance to adapt
6186 the scripts to the local system, e.g., to disable a
6187 service without de-installing the package, or to specify
6188 some special command line options when starting a service,
6189 while making sure their changes aren't lost during the next
6190 package upgrade.
6191 </p>
6194 These scripts should not fail obscurely when the
6195 configuration files remain but the package has been
6196 removed, as configuration files remain on the system after
6197 the package has been removed. Only when <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
6198 is executed with the <tt>--purge</tt> option will
6199 configuration files be removed. In particular, as the
6200 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file> script itself is
6201 usually a <tt>conffile</tt>, it will remain on the system
6202 if the package is removed but not purged. Therefore, you
6203 should include a <tt>test</tt> statement at the top of the
6204 script, like this:
6205 <example compact="compact">
6206 test -f <var>program-executed-later-in-script</var> || exit 0
6207 </example>
6208 </p>
6211 Often there are some variables in the <file>init.d</file>
6212 scripts whose values control the behavior of the scripts,
6213 and which a system administrator is likely to want to
6214 change. As the scripts themselves are frequently
6215 <tt>conffile</tt>s, modifying them requires that the
6216 administrator merge in their changes each time the package
6217 is upgraded and the <tt>conffile</tt> changes. To ease
6218 the burden on the system administrator, such configurable
6219 values should not be placed directly in the script.
6220 Instead, they should be placed in a file in
6221 <file>/etc/default</file>, which typically will have the same
6222 base name as the <file>init.d</file> script. This extra file
6223 should be sourced by the script when the script runs. It
6224 must contain only variable settings and comments in SUSv3
6225 <prgn>sh</prgn> format. It may either be a
6226 <tt>conffile</tt> or a configuration file maintained by
6227 the package maintainer scripts. See <ref id="config-files">
6228 for more details.
6229 </p>
6232 To ensure that vital configurable values are always
6233 available, the <file>init.d</file> script should set default
6234 values for each of the shell variables it uses, either
6235 before sourcing the <file>/etc/default/</file> file or
6236 afterwards using something like the <tt>:
6237 ${VAR:=default}</tt> syntax. Also, the <file>init.d</file>
6238 script must behave sensibly and not fail if the
6239 <file>/etc/default</file> file is deleted.
6240 </p>
6243 <file>/var/run</file> and <file>/var/lock</file> may be mounted
6244 as temporary filesystems<footnote>
6245 For example, using the <tt>RAMRUN</tt> and <tt>RAMLOCK</tt>
6246 options in <file>/etc/default/rcS</file>.
6247 </footnote>, so the <file>init.d</file> scripts must handle this
6248 correctly. This will typically amount to creating any required
6249 subdirectories dynamically when the <file>init.d</file> script
6250 is run, rather than including them in the package and relying on
6251 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to create them.
6252 </p>
6253 </sect1>
6255 <sect1>
6256 <heading>Interfacing with the initscript system</heading>
6259 Maintainers should use the abstraction layer provided by
6260 the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>
6261 programs to deal with initscripts in their packages'
6262 scripts such as <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn>
6263 and <prgn>postrm</prgn>.
6264 </p>
6267 Directly managing the /etc/rc?.d links and directly
6268 invoking the <file>/etc/init.d/</file> initscripts should
6269 be done only by packages providing the initscript
6270 subsystem (such as <prgn>sysv-rc</prgn> and
6271 <prgn>file-rc</prgn>).
6272 </p>
6274 <sect2>
6275 <heading>Managing the links</heading>
6278 The program <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> is provided for
6279 package maintainers to arrange for the proper creation and
6280 removal of <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> symbolic links,
6281 or their functional equivalent if another method is being
6282 used. This may be used by maintainers in their packages'
6283 <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts.
6284 </p>
6287 You must not include any <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file>
6288 symbolic links in the actual archive or manually create or
6289 remove the symbolic links in maintainer scripts; you must
6290 use the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> program instead. (The
6291 former will fail if an alternative method of maintaining
6292 runlevel information is being used.) You must not include
6293 the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories themselves
6294 in the archive either. (Only the <tt>sysvinit</tt>
6295 package may do so.)
6296 </p>
6299 By default <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> will start services in
6300 each of the multi-user state runlevels (2, 3, 4, and 5)
6301 and stop them in the halt runlevel (0), the single-user
6302 runlevel (1) and the reboot runlevel (6). The system
6303 administrator will have the opportunity to customize
6304 runlevels by simply adding, moving, or removing the
6305 symbolic links in <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> if
6306 symbolic links are being used, or by modifying
6307 <file>/etc/runlevel.conf</file> if the <tt>file-rc</tt> method
6308 is being used.
6309 </p>
6312 To get the default behavior for your package, put in your
6313 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script
6314 <example compact="compact">
6315 update-rc.d <var>package</var> defaults
6316 </example>
6317 and in your <prgn>postrm</prgn>
6318 <example compact="compact">
6319 if [ "$1" = purge ]; then
6320 update-rc.d <var>package</var> remove
6322 </example>. Note that if your package changes runlevels
6323 or priority, you may have to remove and recreate the links,
6324 since otherwise the old links may persist. Refer to the
6325 documentation of <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn>.
6326 </p>
6329 This will use a default sequence number of 20. If it does
6330 not matter when or in which order the <file>init.d</file>
6331 script is run, use this default. If it does, then you
6332 should talk to the maintainer of the <prgn>sysvinit</prgn>
6333 package or post to <tt>debian-devel</tt>, and they will
6334 help you choose a number.
6335 </p>
6338 For more information about using <tt>update-rc.d</tt>,
6339 please consult its man page <manref name="update-rc.d"
6340 section="8">.
6341 </p>
6342 </sect2>
6344 <sect2>
6345 <heading>Running initscripts</heading>
6347 The program <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> is provided to make
6348 it easier for package maintainers to properly invoke an
6349 initscript, obeying runlevel and other locally-defined
6350 constraints that might limit a package's right to start,
6351 stop and otherwise manage services. This program may be
6352 used by maintainers in their packages' scripts.
6353 </p>
6356 The package maintainer scripts must use
6357 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> to invoke the
6358 <file>/etc/init.d/*</file> initscripts, instead of
6359 calling them directly.
6360 </p>
6363 By default, <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> will pass any
6364 action requests (start, stop, reload, restart...) to the
6365 <file>/etc/init.d</file> script, filtering out requests
6366 to start or restart a service out of its intended
6367 runlevels.
6368 </p>
6371 Most packages will simply need to change:
6372 <example compact="compact">/etc/init.d/&lt;package&gt;
6373 &lt;action&gt;</example> in their <prgn>postinst</prgn>
6374 and <prgn>prerm</prgn> scripts to:
6375 <example compact="compact">
6376 if which invoke-rc.d >/dev/null 2>&1; then
6377 invoke-rc.d <var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6378 else
6379 /etc/init.d/<var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6381 </example>
6382 </p>
6385 A package should register its initscript services using
6386 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> before it tries to invoke them
6387 using <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>. Invocation of
6388 unregistered services may fail.
6389 </p>
6392 For more information about using
6393 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>, please consult its man page
6394 <manref name="invoke-rc.d" section="8">.
6395 </p>
6396 </sect2>
6397 </sect1>
6399 <sect1>
6400 <heading>Boot-time initialization</heading>
6403 There used to be another directory, <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>,
6404 which contained scripts which were run once per machine
6405 boot. This has been deprecated in favour of links from
6406 <file>/etc/rcS.d</file> to files in <file>/etc/init.d</file> as
6407 described in <ref id="/etc/init.d">. Packages must not
6408 place files in <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>.
6409 </p>
6410 </sect1>
6412 <sect1>
6413 <heading>Example</heading>
6416 An example on which you can base your
6417 <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts is found in
6418 <file>/etc/init.d/skeleton</file>.
6419 </p>
6421 </sect1>
6422 </sect>
6424 <sect>
6425 <heading>Console messages from <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6428 This section describes the formats to be used for messages
6429 written to standard output by the <file>/etc/init.d</file>
6430 scripts. The intent is to improve the consistency of
6431 Debian's startup and shutdown look and feel. For this
6432 reason, please look very carefully at the details. We want
6433 the messages to have the same format in terms of wording,
6434 spaces, punctuation and case of letters.
6435 </p>
6438 Here is a list of overall rules that should be used for
6439 messages generated by <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts.
6440 </p>
6443 <list>
6444 <item>
6445 The message should fit in one line (fewer than 80
6446 characters), start with a capital letter and end with
6447 a period (<tt>.</tt>) and line feed (<tt>"\n"</tt>).
6448 </item>
6450 <item>
6451 If the script is performing some time consuming task in
6452 the background (not merely starting or stopping a
6453 program, for instance), an ellipsis (three dots:
6454 <tt>...</tt>) should be output to the screen, with no
6455 leading or tailing whitespace or line feeds.
6456 </item>
6458 <item>
6459 The messages should appear as if the computer is telling
6460 the user what it is doing (politely :-), but should not
6461 mention "it" directly. For example, instead of:
6462 <example compact="compact">
6463 I'm starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6464 </example>
6465 the message should say
6466 <example compact="compact">
6467 Starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6468 </example>
6469 </item>
6470 </list>
6471 </p>
6474 <tt>init.d</tt> script should use the following standard
6475 message formats for the situations enumerated below.
6476 </p>
6479 <list>
6480 <item>
6481 <p>When daemons are started</p>
6484 If the script starts one or more daemons, the output
6485 should look like this (a single line, no leading
6486 spaces):
6487 <example compact="compact">
6488 Starting <var>description</var>: <var>daemon-1</var> ... <var>daemon-n</var>.
6489 </example>
6490 The <var>description</var> should describe the
6491 subsystem the daemon or set of daemons are part of,
6492 while <var>daemon-1</var> up to <var>daemon-n</var>
6493 denote each daemon's name (typically the file name of
6494 the program).
6495 </p>
6498 For example, the output of <file>/etc/init.d/lpd</file>
6499 would look like:
6500 <example compact="compact">
6501 Starting printer spooler: lpd.
6502 </example>
6503 </p>
6506 This can be achieved by saying
6507 <example compact="compact">
6508 echo -n "Starting printer spooler: lpd"
6509 start-stop-daemon --start --quiet --exec /usr/sbin/lpd
6510 echo "."
6511 </example>
6512 in the script. If there are more than one daemon to
6513 start, the output should look like this:
6514 <example compact="compact">
6515 echo -n "Starting remote file system services:"
6516 echo -n " nfsd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet nfsd
6517 echo -n " mountd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet mountd
6518 echo -n " ugidd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet ugidd
6519 echo "."
6520 </example>
6521 This makes it possible for the user to see what is
6522 happening and when the final daemon has been started.
6523 Care should be taken in the placement of white spaces:
6524 in the example above the system administrators can
6525 easily comment out a line if they don't want to start
6526 a specific daemon, while the displayed message still
6527 looks good.
6528 </p>
6529 </item>
6531 <item>
6532 <p>When a system parameter is being set</p>
6535 If you have to set up different system parameters
6536 during the system boot, you should use this format:
6537 <example compact="compact">
6538 Setting <var>parameter</var> to "<var>value</var>".
6539 </example>
6540 </p>
6543 You can use a statement such as the following to get
6544 the quotes right:
6545 <example compact="compact">
6546 echo "Setting DNS domainname to \"$domainname\"."
6547 </example>
6548 </p>
6551 Note that the same symbol (<tt>"</tt>) <!-- " --> is used
6552 for the left and right quotation marks. A grave accent
6553 (<tt>`</tt>) is not a quote character; neither is an
6554 apostrophe (<tt>'</tt>).
6555 </p>
6556 </item>
6558 <item>
6559 <p>When a daemon is stopped or restarted</p>
6562 When you stop or restart a daemon, you should issue a
6563 message identical to the startup message, except that
6564 <tt>Starting</tt> is replaced with <tt>Stopping</tt>
6565 or <tt>Restarting</tt> respectively.
6566 </p>
6569 For example, stopping the printer daemon will look like
6570 this:
6571 <example compact="compact">
6572 Stopping printer spooler: lpd.
6573 </example>
6574 </p>
6575 </item>
6577 <item>
6578 <p>When something is executed</p>
6581 There are several examples where you have to run a
6582 program at system startup or shutdown to perform a
6583 specific task, for example, setting the system's clock
6584 using <prgn>netdate</prgn> or killing all processes
6585 when the system shuts down. Your message should look
6586 like this:
6587 <example compact="compact">
6588 Doing something very useful...done.
6589 </example>
6590 You should print the <tt>done.</tt> immediately after
6591 the job has been completed, so that the user is
6592 informed why they have to wait. You can get this
6593 behavior by saying
6594 <example compact="compact">
6595 echo -n "Doing something very useful..."
6596 do_something
6597 echo "done."
6598 </example>
6599 in your script.
6600 </p>
6601 </item>
6603 <item>
6604 <p>When the configuration is reloaded</p>
6607 When a daemon is forced to reload its configuration
6608 files you should use the following format:
6609 <example compact="compact">
6610 Reloading <var>description</var> configuration...done.
6611 </example>
6612 where <var>description</var> is the same as in the
6613 daemon starting message.
6614 </p>
6615 </item>
6616 </list>
6617 </p>
6618 </sect>
6620 <sect>
6621 <heading>Cron jobs</heading>
6624 Packages must not modify the configuration file
6625 <file>/etc/crontab</file>, and they must not modify the files in
6626 <file>/var/spool/cron/crontabs</file>.</p>
6629 If a package wants to install a job that has to be executed
6630 via cron, it should place a file with the name of the
6631 package in one or more of the following directories:
6632 <example compact="compact">
6633 /etc/cron.hourly
6634 /etc/cron.daily
6635 /etc/cron.weekly
6636 /etc/cron.monthly
6637 </example>
6638 As these directory names imply, the files within them are
6639 executed on an hourly, daily, weekly, or monthly basis,
6640 respectively. The exact times are listed in
6641 <file>/etc/crontab</file>.</p>
6644 All files installed in any of these directories must be
6645 scripts (e.g., shell scripts or Perl scripts) so that they
6646 can easily be modified by the local system administrator.
6647 In addition, they must be treated as configuration files.
6648 </p>
6651 If a certain job has to be executed at some other frequency or
6652 at a specific time, the package should install a file
6653 <file>/etc/cron.d/<var>package</var></file>. This file uses the
6654 same syntax as <file>/etc/crontab</file> and is processed by
6655 <prgn>cron</prgn> automatically. The file must also be
6656 treated as a configuration file. (Note that entries in the
6657 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> directory are not handled by
6658 <prgn>anacron</prgn>. Thus, you should only use this
6659 directory for jobs which may be skipped if the system is not
6660 running.)</p>
6662 Unlike <file>crontab</file> files described in the IEEE Std
6663 1003.1-2008 (POSIX.1) available from
6664 <url id="http://www.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/9699919799/"
6665 name="The Open Group">, the files in
6666 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> and the file
6667 <file>/etc/crontab</file> have seven fields; namely:
6668 <enumlist>
6669 <item>Minute [0,59]</item>
6670 <item>Hour [0,23]</item>
6671 <item>Day of the month [1,31]</item>
6672 <item>Month of the year [1,12]</item>
6673 <item>Day of the week ([0,6] with 0=Sunday)</item>
6674 <item>Username</item>
6675 <item>Command to be run</item>
6676 </enumlist>
6677 Ranges of numbers are allowed. Ranges are two numbers
6678 separated with a hyphen. The specified range is inclusive.
6679 Lists are allowed. A list is a set of numbers (or ranges)
6680 separated by commas. Step values can be used in conjunction
6681 with ranges.
6682 </p>
6685 The scripts or <tt>crontab</tt> entries in these directories should
6686 check if all necessary programs are installed before they
6687 try to execute them. Otherwise, problems will arise when a
6688 package was removed but not purged since configuration files
6689 are kept on the system in this situation.
6690 </p>
6693 Any <tt>cron</tt> daemon must provide
6694 <file>/usr/bin/crontab</file> and support normal
6695 <tt>crontab</tt> entries as specified in POSIX. The daemon
6696 must also support names for days and months, ranges, and
6697 step values. It has to support <file>/etc/crontab</file>,
6698 and correctly execute the scripts in
6699 <file>/etc/cron.d</file>. The daemon must also correctly
6700 execute scripts in
6701 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>.
6702 </p>
6703 </sect>
6705 <sect id="menus">
6706 <heading>Menus</heading>
6709 The Debian <tt>menu</tt> package provides a standard
6710 interface between packages providing applications and
6711 <em>menu programs</em> (either X window managers or
6712 text-based menu programs such as <prgn>pdmenu</prgn>).
6713 </p>
6716 All packages that provide applications that need not be
6717 passed any special command line arguments for normal
6718 operation should register a menu entry for those
6719 applications, so that users of the <tt>menu</tt> package
6720 will automatically get menu entries in their window
6721 managers, as well in shells like <tt>pdmenu</tt>.
6722 </p>
6725 Menu entries should follow the current menu policy.
6726 </p>
6729 The menu policy can be found in the <tt>menu-policy</tt>
6730 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6731 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6732 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"
6733 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"></tt>.
6734 </p>
6737 Please also refer to the <em>Debian Menu System</em>
6738 documentation that comes with the <package>menu</package>
6739 package for information about how to register your
6740 applications.
6741 </p>
6742 </sect>
6744 <sect id="mime">
6745 <heading>Multimedia handlers</heading>
6748 MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions, RFCs 2045-2049)
6749 is a mechanism for encoding files and data streams and
6750 providing meta-information about them, in particular their
6751 type (e.g. audio or video) and format (e.g. PNG, HTML,
6752 MP3).
6753 </p>
6756 Registration of MIME type handlers allows programs like mail
6757 user agents and web browsers to invoke these handlers to
6758 view, edit or display MIME types they don't support directly.
6759 </p>
6762 Packages which provide the ability to view/show/play,
6763 compose, edit or print MIME types should register themselves
6764 as such following the current MIME support policy.
6765 </p>
6768 The MIME support policy can be found in the <tt>mime-policy</tt>
6769 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6770 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6771 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"
6772 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"></tt>.
6773 </p>
6775 </sect>
6777 <sect>
6778 <heading>Keyboard configuration</heading>
6781 To achieve a consistent keyboard configuration so that all
6782 applications interpret a keyboard event the same way, all
6783 programs in the Debian distribution must be configured to
6784 comply with the following guidelines.
6785 </p>
6788 The following keys must have the specified interpretations:
6790 <taglist>
6791 <tag><tt>&lt;--</tt></tag>
6792 <item>delete the character to the left of the cursor</item>
6794 <tag><tt>Delete</tt></tag>
6795 <item>delete the character to the right of the cursor</item>
6797 <tag><tt>Control+H</tt></tag>
6798 <item>emacs: the help prefix</item>
6799 </taglist>
6801 The interpretation of any keyboard events should be
6802 independent of the terminal that is used, be it a virtual
6803 console, an X terminal emulator, an rlogin/telnet session,
6804 etc.
6805 </p>
6808 The following list explains how the different programs
6809 should be set up to achieve this:
6810 </p>
6813 <list>
6814 <item>
6815 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generates <tt>KB_BackSpace</tt> in X.
6816 </item>
6818 <item>
6819 <tt>Delete</tt> generates <tt>KB_Delete</tt> in X.
6820 </item>
6822 <item>
6823 X translations are set up to make
6824 <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> generate ASCII DEL, and to make
6825 <tt>KB_Delete</tt> generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt> (this
6826 is the vt220 escape code for the "delete character"
6827 key). This must be done by loading the X resources
6828 using <prgn>xrdb</prgn> on all local X displays, not
6829 using the application defaults, so that the
6830 translation resources used correspond to the
6831 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> settings.
6832 </item>
6834 <item>
6835 The Linux console is configured to make
6836 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generate DEL, and <tt>Delete</tt>
6837 generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt>.
6838 </item>
6840 <item>
6841 X applications are configured so that <tt>&lt;</tt>
6842 deletes left, and <tt>Delete</tt> deletes right. Motif
6843 applications already work like this.
6844 </item>
6846 <item>
6847 Terminals should have <tt>stty erase ^?</tt> .
6848 </item>
6850 <item>
6851 The <tt>xterm</tt> terminfo entry should have <tt>ESC
6852 [ 3 ~</tt> for <tt>kdch1</tt>, just as for
6853 <tt>TERM=linux</tt> and <tt>TERM=vt220</tt>.
6854 </item>
6856 <item>
6857 Emacs is programmed to map <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> or
6858 the <tt>stty erase</tt> character to
6859 <tt>delete-backward-char</tt>, and <tt>KB_Delete</tt>
6860 or <tt>kdch1</tt> to <tt>delete-forward-char</tt>, and
6861 <tt>^H</tt> to <tt>help</tt> as always.
6862 </item>
6864 <item>
6865 Other applications use the <tt>stty erase</tt>
6866 character and <tt>kdch1</tt> for the two delete keys,
6867 with ASCII DEL being "delete previous character" and
6868 <tt>kdch1</tt> being "delete character under
6869 cursor".
6870 </item>
6872 </list>
6873 </p>
6876 This will solve the problem except for the following
6877 cases:
6878 </p>
6881 <list>
6882 <item>
6883 Some terminals have a <tt>&lt;--</tt> key that cannot
6884 be made to produce anything except <tt>^H</tt>. On
6885 these terminals Emacs help will be unavailable on
6886 <tt>^H</tt> (assuming that the <tt>stty erase</tt>
6887 character takes precedence in Emacs, and has been set
6888 correctly). <tt>M-x help</tt> or <tt>F1</tt> (if
6889 available) can be used instead.
6890 </item>
6892 <item>
6893 Some operating systems use <tt>^H</tt> for <tt>stty
6894 erase</tt>. However, modern telnet versions and all
6895 rlogin versions propagate <tt>stty</tt> settings, and
6896 almost all UNIX versions honour <tt>stty erase</tt>.
6897 Where the <tt>stty</tt> settings are not propagated
6898 correctly, things can be made to work by using
6899 <tt>stty</tt> manually.
6900 </item>
6902 <item>
6903 Some systems (including previous Debian versions) use
6904 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> to arrange for both
6905 <tt>&lt;--</tt> and <tt>Delete</tt> to generate
6906 <tt>KB_Delete</tt>. We can change the behavior of
6907 their X clients using the same X resources that we use
6908 to do it for our own clients, or configure our clients
6909 using their resources when things are the other way
6910 around. On displays configured like this
6911 <tt>Delete</tt> will not work, but <tt>&lt;--</tt>
6912 will.
6913 </item>
6915 <item>
6916 Some operating systems have different <tt>kdch1</tt>
6917 settings in their <tt>terminfo</tt> database for
6918 <tt>xterm</tt> and others. On these systems the
6919 <tt>Delete</tt> key will not work correctly when you
6920 log in from a system conforming to our policy, but
6921 <tt>&lt;--</tt> will.
6922 </item>
6923 </list>
6924 </p>
6925 </sect>
6927 <sect>
6928 <heading>Environment variables</heading>
6931 A program must not depend on environment variables to get
6932 reasonable defaults. (That's because these environment
6933 variables would have to be set in a system-wide
6934 configuration file like <file>/etc/profile</file>, which is not
6935 supported by all shells.)
6936 </p>
6939 If a program usually depends on environment variables for its
6940 configuration, the program should be changed to fall back to
6941 a reasonable default configuration if these environment
6942 variables are not present. If this cannot be done easily
6943 (e.g., if the source code of a non-free program is not
6944 available), the program must be replaced by a small
6945 "wrapper" shell script which sets the environment variables
6946 if they are not already defined, and calls the original program.
6947 </p>
6950 Here is an example of a wrapper script for this purpose:
6952 <example compact="compact">
6953 #!/bin/sh
6954 BAR=${BAR:-/var/lib/fubar}
6955 export BAR
6956 exec /usr/lib/foo/foo "$@"
6957 </example>
6958 </p>
6961 Furthermore, as <file>/etc/profile</file> is a configuration
6962 file of the <prgn>base-files</prgn> package, other packages must
6963 not put any environment variables or other commands into that
6964 file.
6965 </p>
6966 </sect>
6968 <sect id="doc-base">
6969 <heading>Registering Documents using doc-base</heading>
6972 The <package>doc-base</package> package implements a
6973 flexible mechanism for handling and presenting
6974 documentation. The recommended practice is for every Debian
6975 package that provides online documentation (other than just
6976 manual pages) to register these documents with
6977 <package>doc-base</package> by installing a
6978 <package>doc-base</package> control file via the
6979 <prgn/install-docs/ script at installation time and
6980 de-register the manuals again when the package is removed.
6981 </p>
6983 Please refer to the documentation that comes with the
6984 <package>doc-base</package> package for information and
6985 details.
6986 </p>
6987 </sect>
6989 </chapt>
6992 <chapt id="files">
6993 <heading>Files</heading>
6995 <sect>
6996 <heading>Binaries</heading>
6999 Two different packages must not install programs with
7000 different functionality but with the same filenames. (The
7001 case of two programs having the same functionality but
7002 different implementations is handled via "alternatives" or
7003 the "Conflicts" mechanism. See <ref id="maintscripts"> and
7004 <ref id="conflicts"> respectively.) If this case happens,
7005 one of the programs must be renamed. The maintainers should
7006 report this to the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and
7007 try to find a consensus about which program will have to be
7008 renamed. If a consensus cannot be reached, <em>both</em>
7009 programs must be renamed.
7010 </p>
7013 By default, when a package is being built, any binaries
7014 created should include debugging information, as well as
7015 being compiled with optimization. You should also turn on
7016 as many reasonable compilation warnings as possible; this
7017 makes life easier for porters, who can then look at build
7018 logs for possible problems. For the C programming language,
7019 this means the following compilation parameters should be
7020 used:
7021 <example compact="compact">
7022 CC = gcc
7023 CFLAGS = -O2 -g -Wall # sane warning options vary between programs
7024 LDFLAGS = # none
7025 INSTALL = install -s # (or use strip on the files in debian/tmp)
7026 </example>
7027 </p>
7030 Note that by default all installed binaries should be stripped,
7031 either by using the <tt>-s</tt> flag to
7032 <prgn>install</prgn>, or by calling <prgn>strip</prgn> on
7033 the binaries after they have been copied into
7034 <file>debian/tmp</file> but before the tree is made into a
7035 package.
7036 </p>
7039 Although binaries in the build tree should be compiled with
7040 debugging information by default, it can often be difficult to
7041 debug programs if they are also subjected to compiler
7042 optimization. For this reason, it is recommended to support the
7043 standardized environment variable <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt>
7044 (see <ref id="debianrules-options">). This variable can contain
7045 several flags to change how a package is compiled and built.
7046 </p>
7049 It is up to the package maintainer to decide what
7050 compilation options are best for the package. Certain
7051 binaries (such as computationally-intensive programs) will
7052 function better with certain flags (<tt>-O3</tt>, for
7053 example); feel free to use them. Please use good judgment
7054 here. Don't use flags for the sake of it; only use them
7055 if there is good reason to do so. Feel free to override
7056 the upstream author's ideas about which compilation
7057 options are best: they are often inappropriate for our
7058 environment.
7059 </p>
7060 </sect>
7063 <sect id="libraries">
7064 <heading>Libraries</heading>
7067 If the package is <strong>architecture: any</strong>, then
7068 the shared library compilation and linking flags must have
7069 <tt>-fPIC</tt>, or the package shall not build on some of
7070 the supported architectures<footnote>
7072 If you are using GCC, <tt>-fPIC</tt> produces code with
7073 relocatable position independent code, which is required for
7074 most architectures to create a shared library, with i386 and
7075 perhaps some others where non position independent code is
7076 permitted in a shared library.
7077 </p>
7079 Position independent code may have a performance penalty,
7080 especially on <tt>i386</tt>. However, in most cases the
7081 speed penalty must be measured against the memory wasted on
7082 the few architectures where non position independent code is
7083 even possible.
7084 </p>
7085 </footnote>. Any exception to this rule must be discussed on
7086 the mailing list <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and
7087 a rough consensus obtained. The reasons for not compiling
7088 with <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in the file
7089 <tt>README.Debian</tt>, and care must be taken to either
7090 restrict the architecture or arrange for <tt>-fPIC</tt> to
7091 be used on architectures where it is required.<footnote>
7093 Some of the reasons why this might be required is if the
7094 library contains hand crafted assembly code that is not
7095 relocatable, the speed penalty is excessive for compute
7096 intensive libs, and similar reasons.
7097 </p>
7098 </footnote>
7099 </p>
7101 As to the static libraries, the common case is not to have
7102 relocatable code, since there is no benefit, unless in specific
7103 cases; therefore the static version must not be compiled
7104 with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag. Any exception to this rule
7105 should be discussed on the mailing list
7106 <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and the reasons for
7107 compiling with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in
7108 the file <tt>README.Debian</tt>. <footnote>
7110 Some of the reasons for linking static libraries with
7111 the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag are if, for example, one needs a
7112 Perl API for a library that is under rapid development,
7113 and has an unstable API, so shared libraries are
7114 pointless at this phase of the library's development. In
7115 that case, since Perl needs a library with relocatable
7116 code, it may make sense to create a static library with
7117 relocatable code. Another reason cited is if you are
7118 distilling various libraries into a common shared
7119 library, like <tt>mklibs</tt> does in the Debian
7120 installer project.
7121 </p>
7122 </footnote>
7123 </p>
7125 In other words, if both a shared and a static library is
7126 being built, each source unit (<tt>*.c</tt>, for example,
7127 for C files) will need to be compiled twice, for the normal
7128 case.
7129 </p>
7131 You must specify the gcc option <tt>-D_REENTRANT</tt>
7132 when building a library (either static or shared) to make
7133 the library compatible with LinuxThreads.
7134 </p>
7137 Although not enforced by the build tools, shared libraries
7138 must be linked against all libraries that they use symbols from
7139 in the same way that binaries are. This ensures the correct
7140 functioning of the <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">shlibs</qref>
7141 system and guarantees that all libraries can be safely opened
7142 with <tt>dlopen()</tt>. Packagers may wish to use the gcc
7143 option <tt>-Wl,-z,defs</tt> when building a shared library.
7144 Since this option enforces symbol resolution at build time,
7145 a missing library reference will be caught early as a fatal
7146 build error.
7147 </p>
7150 All installed shared libraries should be stripped with
7151 <example compact="compact">
7152 strip --strip-unneeded <var>your-lib</var>
7153 </example>
7154 (The option <tt>--strip-unneeded</tt> makes
7155 <prgn>strip</prgn> remove only the symbols which aren't
7156 needed for relocation processing.) Shared libraries can
7157 function perfectly well when stripped, since the symbols for
7158 dynamic linking are in a separate part of the ELF object
7159 file.<footnote>
7160 You might also want to use the options
7161 <tt>--remove-section=.comment</tt> and
7162 <tt>--remove-section=.note</tt> on both shared libraries
7163 and executables, and <tt>--strip-debug</tt> on static
7164 libraries.
7165 </footnote>
7166 </p>
7169 Note that under some circumstances it may be useful to
7170 install a shared library unstripped, for example when
7171 building a separate package to support debugging.
7172 </p>
7175 Shared object files (often <file>.so</file> files) that are not
7176 public libraries, that is, they are not meant to be linked
7177 to by third party executables (binaries of other packages),
7178 should be installed in subdirectories of the
7179 <file>/usr/lib</file> directory. Such files are exempt from the
7180 rules that govern ordinary shared libraries, except that
7181 they must not be installed executable and should be
7182 stripped.<footnote>
7183 A common example are the so-called "plug-ins",
7184 internal shared objects that are dynamically loaded by
7185 programs using <manref name="dlopen" section="3">.
7186 </footnote>
7187 </p>
7190 An ever increasing number of packages are using
7191 <prgn>libtool</prgn> to do their linking. The latest GNU
7192 libtools (>= 1.3a) can take advantage of the metadata in the
7193 installed <prgn>libtool</prgn> archive files (<file>*.la</file>
7194 files). The main advantage of <prgn>libtool</prgn>'s
7195 <file>.la</file> files is that it allows <prgn>libtool</prgn> to
7196 store and subsequently access metadata with respect to the
7197 libraries it builds. <prgn>libtool</prgn> will search for
7198 those files, which contain a lot of useful information about
7199 a library (such as library dependency information for static
7200 linking). Also, they're <em>essential</em> for programs
7201 using <tt>libltdl</tt>.<footnote>
7202 Although <prgn>libtool</prgn> is fully capable of
7203 linking against shared libraries which don't have
7204 <tt>.la</tt> files, as it is a mere shell script it can
7205 add considerably to the build time of a
7206 <prgn>libtool</prgn>-using package if that shell script
7207 has to derive all this information from first principles
7208 for each library every time it is linked. With the
7209 advent of <prgn>libtool</prgn> version 1.4 (and to a
7210 lesser extent <prgn>libtool</prgn> version 1.3), the
7211 <file>.la</file> files also store information about
7212 inter-library dependencies which cannot necessarily be
7213 derived after the <file>.la</file> file is deleted.
7214 </footnote>
7215 </p>
7218 Packages that use <prgn>libtool</prgn> to create shared
7219 libraries should include the <file>.la</file> files in the
7220 <tt>-dev</tt> package, unless the package relies on
7221 <tt>libtool</tt>'s <tt>libltdl</tt> library, in which case
7222 the <tt>.la</tt> files must go in the run-time library
7223 package.
7224 </p>
7227 You must make sure that you use only released versions of
7228 shared libraries to build your packages; otherwise other
7229 users will not be able to run your binaries
7230 properly. Producing source packages that depend on
7231 unreleased compilers is also usually a bad
7232 idea.
7233 </p>
7234 </sect>
7237 <sect>
7238 <heading>Shared libraries</heading>
7240 This section has moved to <ref id="sharedlibs">.
7241 </p>
7242 </sect>
7245 <sect id="scripts">
7246 <heading>Scripts</heading>
7249 All command scripts, including the package maintainer
7250 scripts inside the package and used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
7251 should have a <tt>#!</tt> line naming the shell to be used
7252 to interpret them.
7253 </p>
7256 In the case of Perl scripts this should be
7257 <tt>#!/usr/bin/perl</tt>.
7258 </p>
7261 When scripts are installed into a directory in the system
7262 PATH, the script name should not include an extension such
7263 as <tt>.sh</tt> or <tt>.pl</tt> that denotes the scripting
7264 language currently used to implement it.
7265 </p>
7267 Shell scripts (<prgn>sh</prgn> and <prgn>bash</prgn>) other than
7268 <file>init.d</file> scripts should almost certainly start
7269 with <tt>set -e</tt> so that errors are detected.
7270 <file>init.d</file> scripts are something of a special case, due
7271 to how frequently they need to call commands that are allowed to
7272 fail, and it may instead be easier to check the exit status of
7273 commands directly. See <ref id="writing-init"> for more
7274 information about writing <file>init.d</file> scripts.
7275 </p>
7277 Every script should use <tt>set -e</tt> or check the exit status
7278 of <em>every</em> command.
7279 </p>
7281 Scripts may assume that <file>/bin/sh</file> implements the
7282 SUSv3 Shell Command Language<footnote>
7283 Single UNIX Specification, version 3, which is also IEEE
7284 1003.1-2004 (POSIX), and is available on the World Wide Web
7285 from <url id="http://www.unix.org/version3/online.html"
7286 name="The Open Group"> after free
7287 registration.</footnote>
7288 plus the following additional features not mandated by
7289 SUSv3:<footnote>
7290 These features are in widespread use in the Linux community
7291 and are implemented in all of bash, dash, and ksh, the most
7292 common shells users may wish to use as <file>/bin/sh</file>.
7293 </footnote>
7294 <list>
7295 <item><tt>echo -n</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in,
7296 must not generate a newline.</item>
7297 <item><tt>test</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in, must
7298 support <tt>-a</tt> and <tt>-o</tt> as binary logical
7299 operators.</item>
7300 <item><tt>local</tt> to create a scoped variable must be
7301 supported, including listing multiple variables in a single
7302 local command and assigning a value to a variable at the
7303 same time as localizing it. <tt>local</tt> may or
7304 may not preserve the variable value from an outer scope if
7305 no assignment is present. Uses such as:
7306 <example compact>
7307 fname () {
7308 local a b c=delta d
7309 # ... use a, b, c, d ...
7311 </example>
7312 must be supported and must set the value of <tt>c</tt> to
7313 <tt>delta</tt>.
7314 </item>
7315 </list>
7316 If a shell script requires non-SUSv3 features from the shell
7317 interpreter other than those listed above, the appropriate shell
7318 must be specified in the first line of the script (e.g.,
7319 <tt>#!/bin/bash</tt>) and the package must depend on the package
7320 providing the shell (unless the shell package is marked
7321 "Essential", as in the case of <prgn>bash</prgn>).
7322 </p>
7325 You may wish to restrict your script to SUSv3 features plus the
7326 above set when possible so that it may use <file>/bin/sh</file>
7327 as its interpreter. If your script works with <prgn>dash</prgn>
7328 (originally called <prgn>ash</prgn>), it probably complies with
7329 the above requirements, but if you are in doubt, use
7330 <file>/bin/bash</file>.
7331 </p>
7334 Perl scripts should check for errors when making any
7335 system calls, including <tt>open</tt>, <tt>print</tt>,
7336 <tt>close</tt>, <tt>rename</tt> and <tt>system</tt>.
7337 </p>
7340 <prgn>csh</prgn> and <prgn>tcsh</prgn> should be avoided as
7341 scripting languages. See <em>Csh Programming Considered
7342 Harmful</em>, one of the <tt>comp.unix.*</tt> FAQs, which
7343 can be found at <url id="http://www.faqs.org/faqs/unix-faq/shell/csh-whynot/">.
7344 If an upstream package comes with <prgn>csh</prgn> scripts
7345 then you must make sure that they start with
7346 <tt>#!/bin/csh</tt> and make your package depend on the
7347 <prgn>c-shell</prgn> virtual package.
7348 </p>
7351 Any scripts which create files in world-writeable
7352 directories (e.g., in <file>/tmp</file>) must use a
7353 mechanism which will fail atomically if a file with the same
7354 name already exists.
7355 </p>
7358 The Debian base system provides the <prgn>tempfile</prgn>
7359 and <prgn>mktemp</prgn> utilities for use by scripts for
7360 this purpose.
7361 </p>
7362 </sect>
7365 <sect>
7366 <heading>Symbolic links</heading>
7369 In general, symbolic links within a top-level directory
7370 should be relative, and symbolic links pointing from one
7371 top-level directory into another should be absolute. (A
7372 top-level directory is a sub-directory of the root
7373 directory <file>/</file>.)
7374 </p>
7377 In addition, symbolic links should be specified as short as
7378 possible, i.e., link targets like <file>foo/../bar</file> are
7379 deprecated.
7380 </p>
7383 Note that when creating a relative link using
7384 <prgn>ln</prgn> it is not necessary for the target of the
7385 link to exist relative to the working directory you're
7386 running <prgn>ln</prgn> from, nor is it necessary to change
7387 directory to the directory where the link is to be made.
7388 Simply include the string that should appear as the target
7389 of the link (this will be a pathname relative to the
7390 directory in which the link resides) as the first argument
7391 to <prgn>ln</prgn>.
7392 </p>
7395 For example, in your <prgn>Makefile</prgn> or
7396 <file>debian/rules</file>, you can do things like:
7397 <example compact="compact">
7398 ln -fs gcc $(prefix)/bin/cc
7399 ln -fs gcc debian/tmp/usr/bin/cc
7400 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail $(prefix)/bin/runq
7401 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail debian/tmp/usr/bin/runq
7402 </example>
7403 </p>
7406 A symbolic link pointing to a compressed file should always
7407 have the same file extension as the referenced file. (For
7408 example, if a file <file>foo.gz</file> is referenced by a
7409 symbolic link, the filename of the link has to end with
7410 "<file>.gz</file>" too, as in <file>bar.gz</file>.)
7411 </p>
7412 </sect>
7414 <sect>
7415 <heading>Device files</heading>
7418 Packages must not include device files or named pipes in the
7419 package file tree.
7420 </p>
7423 If a package needs any special device files that are not
7424 included in the base system, it must call
7425 <prgn>MAKEDEV</prgn> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script,
7426 after notifying the user<footnote>
7427 This notification could be done via a (low-priority)
7428 debconf message, or an echo (printf) statement.
7429 </footnote>.
7430 </p>
7433 Packages must not remove any device files in the
7434 <prgn>postrm</prgn> or any other script. This is left to the
7435 system administrator.
7436 </p>
7439 Debian uses the serial devices
7440 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>. Programs using the old
7441 <file>/dev/cu*</file> devices should be changed to use
7442 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>.
7443 </p>
7446 Named pipes needed by the package must be created in
7447 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script<footnote>
7448 It's better to use <prgn>mkfifo</prgn> rather
7449 than <prgn>mknod</prgn> to create named pipes so that
7450 automated checks for packages incorrectly creating device
7451 files with <prgn>mknod</prgn> won't have false positives.
7452 </footnote> and removed in
7453 the <prgn>prerm</prgn> or <prgn>postrm</prgn> script as
7454 appropriate.
7455 </p>
7456 </sect>
7458 <sect id="config-files">
7459 <heading>Configuration files</heading>
7461 <sect1>
7462 <heading>Definitions</heading>
7465 <taglist>
7466 <tag>configuration file</tag>
7467 <item>
7468 A file that affects the operation of a program, or
7469 provides site- or host-specific information, or
7470 otherwise customizes the behavior of a program.
7471 Typically, configuration files are intended to be
7472 modified by the system administrator (if needed or
7473 desired) to conform to local policy or to provide
7474 more useful site-specific behavior.
7475 </item>
7477 <tag><tt>conffile</tt></tag>
7478 <item>
7479 A file listed in a package's <tt>conffiles</tt>
7480 file, and is treated specially by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
7481 (see <ref id="configdetails">).
7482 </item>
7483 </taglist>
7484 </p>
7487 The distinction between these two is important; they are
7488 not interchangeable concepts. Almost all
7489 <tt>conffile</tt>s are configuration files, but many
7490 configuration files are not <tt>conffiles</tt>.
7491 </p>
7494 As noted elsewhere, <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts,
7495 <file>/etc/default</file> files, scripts installed in
7496 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>, and cron
7497 configuration installed in <file>/etc/cron.d</file> must be
7498 treated as configuration files. In general, any script that
7499 embeds configuration information is de-facto a configuration
7500 file and should be treated as such.
7501 </p>
7502 </sect1>
7504 <sect1>
7505 <heading>Location</heading>
7508 Any configuration files created or used by your package
7509 must reside in <file>/etc</file>. If there are several,
7510 consider creating a subdirectory of <file>/etc</file>
7511 named after your package.
7512 </p>
7515 If your package creates or uses configuration files
7516 outside of <file>/etc</file>, and it is not feasible to modify
7517 the package to use <file>/etc</file> directly, put the files
7518 in <file>/etc</file> and create symbolic links to those files
7519 from the location that the package requires.
7520 </p>
7521 </sect1>
7523 <sect1>
7524 <heading>Behavior</heading>
7527 Configuration file handling must conform to the following
7528 behavior:
7529 <list compact="compact">
7530 <item>
7531 local changes must be preserved during a package
7532 upgrade, and
7533 </item>
7534 <item>
7535 configuration files must be preserved when the
7536 package is removed, and only deleted when the
7537 package is purged.
7538 </item>
7539 </list>
7540 </p>
7543 The easy way to achieve this behavior is to make the
7544 configuration file a <tt>conffile</tt>. This is
7545 appropriate only if it is possible to distribute a default
7546 version that will work for most installations, although
7547 some system administrators may choose to modify it. This
7548 implies that the default version will be part of the
7549 package distribution, and must not be modified by the
7550 maintainer scripts during installation (or at any other
7551 time).
7552 </p>
7555 In order to ensure that local changes are preserved
7556 correctly, no package may contain or make hard links to
7557 conffiles.<footnote>
7558 Rationale: There are two problems with hard links.
7559 The first is that some editors break the link while
7560 editing one of the files, so that the two files may
7561 unwittingly become unlinked and different. The second
7562 is that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> might break the hard link
7563 while upgrading <tt>conffile</tt>s.
7564 </footnote>
7565 </p>
7568 The other way to do it is via the maintainer scripts. In
7569 this case, the configuration file must not be listed as a
7570 <tt>conffile</tt> and must not be part of the package
7571 distribution. If the existence of a file is required for
7572 the package to be sensibly configured it is the
7573 responsibility of the package maintainer to provide
7574 maintainer scripts which correctly create, update and
7575 maintain the file and remove it on purge. (See <ref
7576 id="maintainerscripts"> for more information.) These
7577 scripts must be idempotent (i.e., must work correctly if
7578 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> needs to re-run them due to errors
7579 during installation or removal), must cope with all the
7580 variety of ways <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can call maintainer
7581 scripts, must not overwrite or otherwise mangle the user's
7582 configuration without asking, must not ask unnecessary
7583 questions (particularly during upgrades), and must
7584 otherwise be good citizens.
7585 </p>
7588 The scripts are not required to configure every possible
7589 option for the package, but only those necessary to get
7590 the package running on a given system. Ideally the
7591 sysadmin should not have to do any configuration other
7592 than that done (semi-)automatically by the
7593 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
7594 </p>
7597 A common practice is to create a script called
7598 <file><var>package</var>-configure</file> and have the
7599 package's <prgn>postinst</prgn> call it if and only if the
7600 configuration file does not already exist. In certain
7601 cases it is useful for there to be an example or template
7602 file which the maintainer scripts use. Such files should
7603 be in <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var></file> or
7604 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var></file> (depending on whether
7605 they are architecture-independent or not). There should
7606 be symbolic links to them from
7607 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file> if
7608 they are examples, and should be perfectly ordinary
7609 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled files (<em>not</em>
7610 configuration files).
7611 </p>
7614 These two styles of configuration file handling must
7615 not be mixed, for that way lies madness:
7616 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will ask about overwriting the file
7617 every time the package is upgraded.
7618 </p>
7619 </sect1>
7621 <sect1>
7622 <heading>Sharing configuration files</heading>
7625 Packages which specify the same file as a
7626 <tt>conffile</tt> must be tagged as <em>conflicting</em>
7627 with each other. (This is an instance of the general rule
7628 about not sharing files. Note that neither alternatives
7629 nor diversions are likely to be appropriate in this case;
7630 in particular, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not handle diverted
7631 <tt>conffile</tt>s well.)
7632 </p>
7635 The maintainer scripts must not alter a <tt>conffile</tt>
7636 of <em>any</em> package, including the one the scripts
7637 belong to.
7638 </p>
7641 If two or more packages use the same configuration file
7642 and it is reasonable for both to be installed at the same
7643 time, one of these packages must be defined as
7644 <em>owner</em> of the configuration file, i.e., it will be
7645 the package which handles that file as a configuration
7646 file. Other packages that use the configuration file must
7647 depend on the owning package if they require the
7648 configuration file to operate. If the other package will
7649 use the configuration file if present, but is capable of
7650 operating without it, no dependency need be declared.
7651 </p>
7654 If it is desirable for two or more related packages to
7655 share a configuration file <em>and</em> for all of the
7656 related packages to be able to modify that configuration
7657 file, then the following should be done:
7658 <enumlist compact="compact">
7659 <item>
7660 One of the related packages (the "owning" package)
7661 will manage the configuration file with maintainer
7662 scripts as described in the previous section.
7663 </item>
7664 <item>
7665 The owning package should also provide a program
7666 that the other packages may use to modify the
7667 configuration file.
7668 </item>
7669 <item>
7670 The related packages must use the provided program
7671 to make any desired modifications to the
7672 configuration file. They should either depend on
7673 the core package to guarantee that the configuration
7674 modifier program is available or accept gracefully
7675 that they cannot modify the configuration file if it
7676 is not. (This is in addition to the fact that the
7677 configuration file may not even be present in the
7678 latter scenario.)
7679 </item>
7680 </enumlist>
7681 </p>
7684 Sometimes it's appropriate to create a new package which
7685 provides the basic infrastructure for the other packages
7686 and which manages the shared configuration files. (The
7687 <tt>sgml-base</tt> package is a good example.)
7688 </p>
7689 </sect1>
7691 <sect1>
7692 <heading>User configuration files ("dotfiles")</heading>
7695 The files in <file>/etc/skel</file> will automatically be
7696 copied into new user accounts by <prgn>adduser</prgn>.
7697 No other program should reference the files in
7698 <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7699 </p>
7702 Therefore, if a program needs a dotfile to exist in
7703 advance in <file>$HOME</file> to work sensibly, that dotfile
7704 should be installed in <file>/etc/skel</file> and treated as a
7705 configuration file.
7706 </p>
7709 However, programs that require dotfiles in order to
7710 operate sensibly are a bad thing, unless they do create
7711 the dotfiles themselves automatically.
7712 </p>
7715 Furthermore, programs should be configured by the Debian
7716 default installation to behave as closely to the upstream
7717 default behavior as possible.
7718 </p>
7721 Therefore, if a program in a Debian package needs to be
7722 configured in some way in order to operate sensibly, that
7723 should be done using a site-wide configuration file placed
7724 in <file>/etc</file>. Only if the program doesn't support a
7725 site-wide default configuration and the package maintainer
7726 doesn't have time to add it may a default per-user file be
7727 placed in <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7728 </p>
7731 <file>/etc/skel</file> should be as empty as we can make it.
7732 This is particularly true because there is no easy (or
7733 necessarily desirable) mechanism for ensuring that the
7734 appropriate dotfiles are copied into the accounts of
7735 existing users when a package is installed.
7736 </p>
7737 </sect1>
7738 </sect>
7740 <sect>
7741 <heading>Log files</heading>
7743 Log files should usually be named
7744 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var>.log</file>. If you have many
7745 log files, or need a separate directory for permission
7746 reasons (<file>/var/log</file> is writable only by
7747 <file>root</file>), you should usually create a directory named
7748 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var></file> and place your log
7749 files there.
7750 </p>
7753 Log files must be rotated occasionally so that they don't
7754 grow indefinitely; the best way to do this is to drop a log
7755 rotation configuration file into the directory
7756 <file>/etc/logrotate.d</file> and use the facilities provided by
7757 logrotate.<footnote>
7759 The traditional approach to log files has been to set up
7760 <em>ad hoc</em> log rotation schemes using simple shell
7761 scripts and cron. While this approach is highly
7762 customizable, it requires quite a lot of sysadmin work.
7763 Even though the original Debian system helped a little
7764 by automatically installing a system which can be used
7765 as a template, this was deemed not enough.
7766 </p>
7769 The use of <prgn>logrotate</prgn>, a program developed
7770 by Red Hat, is better, as it centralizes log management.
7771 It has both a configuration file
7772 (<file>/etc/logrotate.conf</file>) and a directory where
7773 packages can drop their individual log rotation
7774 configurations (<file>/etc/logrotate.d</file>).
7775 </p>
7776 </footnote>
7777 Here is a good example for a logrotate config
7778 file (for more information see <manref name="logrotate"
7779 section="8">):
7780 <example compact="compact">
7781 /var/log/foo/*.log {
7782 rotate 12
7783 weekly
7784 compress
7785 postrotate
7786 /etc/init.d/foo force-reload
7787 endscript
7789 </example>
7790 This rotates all files under <file>/var/log/foo</file>, saves 12
7791 compressed generations, and forces the daemon to reload its
7792 configuration information after the log rotation.
7793 </p>
7796 Log files should be removed when the package is
7797 purged (but not when it is only removed). This should be
7798 done by the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script when it is called
7799 with the argument <tt>purge</tt> (see <ref
7800 id="removedetails">).
7801 </p>
7802 </sect>
7804 <sect>
7805 <heading>Permissions and owners</heading>
7808 The rules in this section are guidelines for general use.
7809 If necessary you may deviate from the details below.
7810 However, if you do so you must make sure that what is done
7811 is secure and you should try to be as consistent as possible
7812 with the rest of the system. You should probably also
7813 discuss it on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> first.
7814 </p>
7817 Files should be owned by <tt>root:root</tt>, and made
7818 writable only by the owner and universally readable (and
7819 executable, if appropriate), that is mode 644 or 755.
7820 </p>
7823 Directories should be mode 755 or (for group-writability)
7824 mode 2775. The ownership of the directory should be
7825 consistent with its mode: if a directory is mode 2775, it
7826 should be owned by the group that needs write access to
7827 it.<footnote>
7829 When a package is upgraded, and the owner or permissions
7830 of a file included in the package has changed, dpkg
7831 arranges for the ownership and permissions to be
7832 correctly set upon installation. However, this does not
7833 extend to directories; the permissions and ownership of
7834 directories already on the system does not change on
7835 install or upgrade of packages. This makes sense, since
7836 otherwise common directories like <tt>/usr</tt> would
7837 always be in flux. To correctly change permissions of a
7838 directory the package owns, explicit action is required,
7839 usually in the <tt>postinst</tt> script. Care must be
7840 taken to handle downgrades as well, in that case.
7841 </p>
7842 </footnote>
7843 </p>
7847 Setuid and setgid executables should be mode 4755 or 2755
7848 respectively, and owned by the appropriate user or group.
7849 They should not be made unreadable (modes like 4711 or
7850 2711 or even 4111); doing so achieves no extra security,
7851 because anyone can find the binary in the freely available
7852 Debian package; it is merely inconvenient. For the same
7853 reason you should not restrict read or execute permissions
7854 on non-set-id executables.
7855 </p>
7858 Some setuid programs need to be restricted to particular
7859 sets of users, using file permissions. In this case they
7860 should be owned by the uid to which they are set-id, and by
7861 the group which should be allowed to execute them. They
7862 should have mode 4754; again there is no point in making
7863 them unreadable to those users who must not be allowed to
7864 execute them.
7865 </p>
7868 It is possible to arrange that the system administrator can
7869 reconfigure the package to correspond to their local
7870 security policy by changing the permissions on a binary:
7871 they can do this by using <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>, as
7872 described below.<footnote>
7873 Ordinary files installed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> (as
7874 opposed to <tt>conffile</tt>s and other similar objects)
7875 normally have their permissions reset to the distributed
7876 permissions when the package is reinstalled. However,
7877 the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> overrides this
7878 default behavior.
7879 </footnote>
7880 Another method you should consider is to create a group for
7881 people allowed to use the program(s) and make any setuid
7882 executables executable only by that group.
7883 </p>
7886 If you need to create a new user or group for your package
7887 there are two possibilities. Firstly, you may need to
7888 make some files in the binary package be owned by this
7889 user or group, or you may need to compile the user or
7890 group id (rather than just the name) into the binary
7891 (though this latter should be avoided if possible, as in
7892 this case you need a statically allocated id).</p>
7895 If you need a statically allocated id, you must ask for a
7896 user or group id from the <tt>base-passwd</tt> maintainer,
7897 and must not release the package until you have been
7898 allocated one. Once you have been allocated one you must
7899 either make the package depend on a version of the
7900 <tt>base-passwd</tt> package with the id present in
7901 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file>, or arrange for
7902 your package to create the user or group itself with the
7903 correct id (using <tt>adduser</tt>) in its
7904 <prgn>preinst</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>. (Doing it in
7905 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is to be preferred if it is
7906 possible, otherwise a pre-dependency will be needed on the
7907 <tt>adduser</tt> package.)
7908 </p>
7911 On the other hand, the program might be able to determine
7912 the uid or gid from the user or group name at runtime, so
7913 that a dynamically allocated id can be used. In this case
7914 you should choose an appropriate user or group name,
7915 discussing this on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> and checking
7916 with the <package/base-passwd/ maintainer that it is unique and that
7917 they do not wish you to use a statically allocated id
7918 instead. When this has been checked you must arrange for
7919 your package to create the user or group if necessary using
7920 <prgn>adduser</prgn> in the <prgn>preinst</prgn> or
7921 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script (again, the latter is to be
7922 preferred if it is possible).
7923 </p>
7926 Note that changing the numeric value of an id associated
7927 with a name is very difficult, and involves searching the
7928 file system for all appropriate files. You need to think
7929 carefully whether a static or dynamic id is required, since
7930 changing your mind later will cause problems.
7931 </p>
7933 <sect1><heading>The use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn></heading>
7935 This section is not intended as policy, but as a
7936 description of the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>.
7937 </p>
7940 If a system administrator wishes to have a file (or
7941 directory or other such thing) installed with owner and
7942 permissions different from those in the distributed Debian
7943 package, they can use the <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>
7944 program to instruct <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to use the different
7945 settings every time the file is installed. Thus the
7946 package maintainer should distribute the files with their
7947 normal permissions, and leave it for the system
7948 administrator to make any desired changes. For example, a
7949 daemon which is normally required to be setuid root, but
7950 in certain situations could be used without being setuid,
7951 should be installed setuid in the <tt>.deb</tt>. Then the
7952 local system administrator can change this if they wish.
7953 If there are two standard ways of doing it, the package
7954 maintainer can use <tt>debconf</tt> to find out the
7955 preference, and call <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> in the
7956 maintainer script if necessary to accommodate the system
7957 administrator's choice. Care must be taken during
7958 upgrades to not override an existing setting.
7959 </p>
7962 Given the above, <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> is
7963 essentially a tool for system administrators and would not
7964 normally be needed in the maintainer scripts. There is
7965 one type of situation, though, where calls to
7966 <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> would be needed in the
7967 maintainer scripts, and that involves packages which use
7968 dynamically allocated user or group ids. In such a
7969 situation, something like the following idiom can be very
7970 helpful in the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>, where
7971 <tt>sysuser</tt> is a dynamically allocated id:
7972 <example>
7973 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
7975 # only do something when no setting exists
7976 if ! dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
7977 then
7978 #include: debconf processing, question about foo and bar
7979 if [ "$RET" = "true" ] ; then
7980 dpkg-statoverride --update --add sysuser root 4755 $i
7983 done
7984 </example>
7985 The corresponding code to remove the override when the package
7986 is purged would be:
7987 <example>
7988 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
7990 if dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
7991 then
7992 dpkg-statoverride --remove $i
7994 done
7995 </example>
7996 </p>
7997 </sect1>
7998 </sect>
7999 </chapt>
8002 <chapt id="customized-programs">
8003 <heading>Customized programs</heading>
8005 <sect id="arch-spec">
8006 <heading>Architecture specification strings</heading>
8009 If a program needs to specify an <em>architecture specification
8010 string</em> in some place, it should select one of the strings
8011 provided by <tt>dpkg-architecture -L</tt>. The strings are in
8012 the format <tt><var>os</var>-<var>arch</var></tt>, though the OS
8013 part is sometimes elided, as when the OS is Linux.
8014 </p>
8017 Note that we don't want to use
8018 <tt><var>arch</var>-debian-linux</tt> to apply to the rule
8019 <tt><var>architecture</var>-<var>vendor</var>-<var>os</var></tt>
8020 since this would make our programs incompatible with other
8021 Linux distributions. We also don't use something like
8022 <tt><var>arch</var>-unknown-linux</tt>, since the
8023 <tt>unknown</tt> does not look very good.
8024 </p>
8026 <sect1 id="arch-wildcard-spec">
8027 <heading>Architecture wildcards</heading>
8030 A package may specify an architecture wildcard. Architecture
8031 wildcards are in the format <tt>any</tt> (which matches every
8032 architecture), <tt><var>os</var></tt>-any, or
8033 any-<tt><var>cpu</var></tt>. <footnote>
8034 Internally, the package system normalizes the GNU triplets
8035 and the Debian arches into Debian arch triplets (which are
8036 kind of inverted GNU triplets), with the first component of
8037 the triplet representing the libc and ABI in use, and then
8038 does matching against those triplets. However, such
8039 triplets are an internal implementation detail that should
8040 not be used by packages directly. The libc and ABI portion
8041 is handled internally by the package system based on
8042 the <var>os</var> and <var>cpu</var>.
8043 </footnote>
8044 </p>
8045 </sect1>
8046 </sect>
8048 <sect>
8049 <heading>Daemons</heading>
8052 The configuration files <file>/etc/services</file>,
8053 <file>/etc/protocols</file>, and <file>/etc/rpc</file> are managed
8054 by the <prgn>netbase</prgn> package and must not be modified
8055 by other packages.
8056 </p>
8059 If a package requires a new entry in one of these files, the
8060 maintainer should get in contact with the
8061 <prgn>netbase</prgn> maintainer, who will add the entries
8062 and release a new version of the <prgn>netbase</prgn>
8063 package.
8064 </p>
8067 The configuration file <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file> must not be
8068 modified by the package's scripts except via the
8069 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script or the
8070 <file>DebianNet.pm</file> Perl module. See their documentation
8071 for details on how to add entries.
8072 </p>
8075 If a package wants to install an example entry into
8076 <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file>, the entry must be preceded with
8077 exactly one hash character (<tt>#</tt>). Such lines are
8078 treated as "commented out by user" by the
8079 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script and are not changed or
8080 activated during package updates.
8081 </p>
8082 </sect>
8084 <sect>
8085 <heading>Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and
8086 lastlog</heading>
8089 Some programs need to create pseudo-ttys. This should be done
8090 using Unix98 ptys if the C library supports it. The resulting
8091 program must not be installed setuid root, unless that
8092 is required for other functionality.
8093 </p>
8096 The files <file>/var/run/utmp</file>, <file>/var/log/wtmp</file> and
8097 <file>/var/log/lastlog</file> must be installed writable by
8098 group <tt>utmp</tt>. Programs which need to modify those
8099 files must be installed setgid <tt>utmp</tt>.
8100 </p>
8101 </sect>
8103 <sect>
8104 <heading>Editors and pagers</heading>
8107 Some programs have the ability to launch an editor or pager
8108 program to edit or display a text document. Since there are
8109 lots of different editors and pagers available in the Debian
8110 distribution, the system administrator and each user should
8111 have the possibility to choose their preferred editor and
8112 pager.
8113 </p>
8116 In addition, every program should choose a good default
8117 editor/pager if none is selected by the user or system
8118 administrator.
8119 </p>
8122 Thus, every program that launches an editor or pager must
8123 use the EDITOR or PAGER environment variable to determine
8124 the editor or pager the user wishes to use. If these
8125 variables are not set, the programs <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
8126 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> should be used, respectively.
8127 </p>
8130 These two files are managed through the <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
8131 "alternatives" mechanism. Thus every package providing an
8132 editor or pager must call the
8133 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> script to register these
8134 programs.
8135 </p>
8138 If it is very hard to adapt a program to make use of the
8139 EDITOR or PAGER variables, that program may be configured to
8140 use <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> and
8141 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-pager</file> as the editor or pager
8142 program respectively. These are two scripts provided in the
8143 <package>sensible-utils</package> package that check the EDITOR
8144 and PAGER variables and launch the appropriate program, and fall
8145 back to <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
8146 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> if the variable is not set.
8147 </p>
8150 A program may also use the VISUAL environment variable to
8151 determine the user's choice of editor. If it exists, it
8152 should take precedence over EDITOR. This is in fact what
8153 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> does.
8154 </p>
8157 It is not required for a package to depend on
8158 <tt>editor</tt> and <tt>pager</tt>, nor is it required for a
8159 package to provide such virtual packages.<footnote>
8160 The Debian base system already provides an editor and a
8161 pager program.
8162 </footnote>
8163 </p>
8164 </sect>
8166 <sect id="web-appl">
8167 <heading>Web servers and applications</heading>
8170 This section describes the locations and URLs that should
8171 be used by all web servers and web applications in the
8172 Debian system.
8173 </p>
8176 <enumlist>
8177 <item>
8178 Cgi-bin executable files are installed in the
8179 directory
8180 <example compact="compact">
8181 /usr/lib/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
8182 </example>
8183 and should be referred to as
8184 <example compact="compact">
8185 http://localhost/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
8186 </example>
8188 </item>
8190 <item>
8191 <p>Access to HTML documents</p>
8194 HTML documents for a package are stored in
8195 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
8196 and can be referred to as
8197 <example compact="compact">
8198 http://localhost/doc/<var>package</var>/<var>filename</var>
8199 </example>
8200 </p>
8203 The web server should restrict access to the document
8204 tree so that only clients on the same host can read
8205 the documents. If the web server does not support such
8206 access controls, then it should not provide access at
8207 all, or ask about providing access during installation.
8208 </p>
8209 </item>
8211 <item>
8212 <p>Access to images</p>
8214 It is recommended that images for a package be stored
8215 in <tt>/usr/share/images/<var>package</var></tt> and
8216 may be referred to through an alias <tt>/images/</tt>
8218 <example>
8219 http://localhost/images/&lt;package&gt;/&lt;filename&gt;
8220 </example>
8222 </p>
8223 </item>
8225 <item>
8226 <p>Web Document Root</p>
8229 Web Applications should try to avoid storing files in
8230 the Web Document Root. Instead they should use the
8231 /usr/share/doc/<var>package</var> directory for
8232 documents and register the Web Application via the
8233 <package>doc-base</package> package. If access to the
8234 web document root is unavoidable then use
8235 <example compact="compact">
8236 /var/www
8237 </example>
8238 as the Document Root. This might be just a symbolic
8239 link to the location where the system administrator
8240 has put the real document root.
8241 </p>
8242 </item>
8243 <item><p>Providing httpd and/or httpd-cgi</p>
8245 All web servers should provide the virtual package
8246 <tt>httpd</tt>. If a web server has CGI support it should
8247 provide <tt>httpd-cgi</tt> additionally.
8248 </p>
8250 All web applications which do not contain CGI scripts should
8251 depend on <tt>httpd</tt>, all those web applications which
8252 <tt>do</tt> contain CGI scripts, should depend on
8253 <tt>httpd-cgi</tt>.
8254 </p>
8255 </item>
8256 </enumlist>
8257 </p>
8258 </sect>
8260 <sect id="mail-transport-agents">
8261 <heading>Mail transport, delivery and user agents</heading>
8264 Debian packages which process electronic mail, whether mail
8265 user agents (MUAs) or mail transport agents (MTAs), must
8266 ensure that they are compatible with the configuration
8267 decisions below. Failure to do this may result in lost
8268 mail, broken <tt>From:</tt> lines, and other serious brain
8269 damage!
8270 </p>
8273 The mail spool is <file>/var/mail</file> and the interface to
8274 send a mail message is <file>/usr/sbin/sendmail</file> (as per
8275 the FHS). On older systems, the mail spool may be
8276 physically located in <file>/var/spool/mail</file>, but all
8277 access to the mail spool should be via the
8278 <file>/var/mail</file> symlink. The mail spool is part of the
8279 base system and not part of the MTA package.
8280 </p>
8283 All Debian MUAs, MTAs, MDAs and other mailbox accessing
8284 programs (such as IMAP daemons) must lock the mailbox in an
8285 NFS-safe way. This means that <tt>fcntl()</tt> locking must
8286 be combined with dot locking. To avoid deadlocks, a program
8287 should use <tt>fcntl()</tt> first and dot locking after
8288 this, or alternatively implement the two locking methods in
8289 a non blocking way<footnote>
8290 If it is not possible to establish both locks, the
8291 system shouldn't wait for the second lock to be
8292 established, but remove the first lock, wait a (random)
8293 time, and start over locking again.
8294 </footnote>. Using the functions <tt>maillock</tt> and
8295 <tt>mailunlock</tt> provided by the
8296 <tt>liblockfile*</tt><footnote>
8297 You will need to depend on <tt>liblockfile1 (&gt;&gt;1.01)</tt>
8298 to use these functions.
8299 </footnote> packages is the recommended way to realize this.
8300 </p>
8303 Mailboxes are generally either mode 600 and owned by
8304 <var>user</var> or mode 660 and owned by
8305 <tt><var>user</var>:mail</tt><footnote>
8306 There are two traditional permission schemes for mail spools:
8307 mode 600 with all mail delivery done by processes running as
8308 the destination user, or mode 660 and owned by group mail with
8309 mail delivery done by a process running as a system user in
8310 group mail. Historically, Debian required mode 660 mail
8311 spools to enable the latter model, but that model has become
8312 increasingly uncommon and the principle of least privilege
8313 indicates that mail systems that use the first model should
8314 use permissions of 600. If delivery to programs is permitted,
8315 it's easier to keep the mail system secure if the delivery
8316 agent runs as the destination user. Debian Policy therefore
8317 permits either scheme.
8318 </footnote>. The local system administrator may choose a
8319 different permission scheme; packages should not make
8320 assumptions about the permission and ownership of mailboxes
8321 unless required (such as when creating a new mailbox). A MUA
8322 may remove a mailbox (unless it has nonstandard permissions) in
8323 which case the MTA or another MUA must recreate it if needed.
8324 </p>
8327 The mail spool is 2775 <tt>root:mail</tt>, and MUAs should
8328 be setgid mail to do the locking mentioned above (and
8329 must obviously avoid accessing other users' mailboxes
8330 using this privilege).</p>
8333 <file>/etc/aliases</file> is the source file for the system mail
8334 aliases (e.g., postmaster, usenet, etc.), it is the one
8335 which the sysadmin and <prgn>postinst</prgn> scripts may
8336 edit. After <file>/etc/aliases</file> is edited the program or
8337 human editing it must call <prgn>newaliases</prgn>. All MTA
8338 packages must come with a <prgn>newaliases</prgn> program,
8339 even if it does nothing, but older MTA packages did not do
8340 this so programs should not fail if <prgn>newaliases</prgn>
8341 cannot be found. Note that because of this, all MTA
8342 packages must have <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt> and
8343 <tt>Replaces: mail-transport-agent</tt> control file
8344 fields.
8345 </p>
8348 The convention of writing <tt>forward to
8349 <var>address</var></tt> in the mailbox itself is not
8350 supported. Use a <tt>.forward</tt> file instead.</p>
8353 The <prgn>rmail</prgn> program used by UUCP
8354 for incoming mail should be <file>/usr/sbin/rmail</file>.
8355 Likewise, <prgn>rsmtp</prgn>, for receiving
8356 batch-SMTP-over-UUCP, should be <file>/usr/sbin/rsmtp</file> if it
8357 is supported.</p>
8360 If your package needs to know what hostname to use on (for
8361 example) outgoing news and mail messages which are generated
8362 locally, you should use the file <file>/etc/mailname</file>. It
8363 will contain the portion after the username and <tt>@</tt>
8364 (at) sign for email addresses of users on the machine
8365 (followed by a newline).
8366 </p>
8369 Such a package should check for the existence of this file
8370 when it is being configured. If it exists, it should be
8371 used without comment, although an MTA's configuration script
8372 may wish to prompt the user even if it finds that this file
8373 exists. If the file does not exist, the package should
8374 prompt the user for the value (preferably using
8375 <prgn>debconf</prgn>) and store it in <file>/etc/mailname</file>
8376 as well as using it in the package's configuration. The
8377 prompt should make it clear that the name will not just be
8378 used by that package. For example, in this situation the
8379 <tt>inn</tt> package could say something like:
8380 <example compact="compact">
8381 Please enter the "mail name" of your system. This is the
8382 hostname portion of the address to be shown on outgoing
8383 news and mail messages. The default is
8384 <var>syshostname</var>, your system's host name. Mail
8385 name ["<var>syshostname</var>"]:
8386 </example>
8387 where <var>syshostname</var> is the output of <tt>hostname
8388 --fqdn</tt>.
8389 </p>
8390 </sect>
8392 <sect>
8393 <heading>News system configuration</heading>
8396 All the configuration files related to the NNTP (news)
8397 servers and clients should be located under
8398 <file>/etc/news</file>.</p>
8401 There are some configuration issues that apply to a number
8402 of news clients and server packages on the machine. These
8403 are:
8405 <taglist>
8406 <tag><file>/etc/news/organization</file></tag>
8407 <item>
8408 A string which should appear as the
8409 organization header for all messages posted
8410 by NNTP clients on the machine
8411 </item>
8413 <tag><file>/etc/news/server</file></tag>
8414 <item>
8415 Contains the FQDN of the upstream NNTP
8416 server, or localhost if the local machine is
8417 an NNTP server.
8418 </item>
8419 </taglist>
8421 Other global files may be added as required for cross-package news
8422 configuration.
8423 </p>
8424 </sect>
8427 <sect>
8428 <heading>Programs for the X Window System</heading>
8430 <sect1>
8431 <heading>Providing X support and package priorities</heading>
8434 Programs that can be configured with support for the X
8435 Window System must be configured to do so and must declare
8436 any package dependencies necessary to satisfy their
8437 runtime requirements when using the X Window System. If
8438 such a package is of higher priority than the X packages
8439 on which it depends, it is required that either the
8440 X-specific components be split into a separate package, or
8441 that an alternative version of the package, which includes
8442 X support, be provided, or that the package's priority be
8443 lowered.
8444 </p>
8445 </sect1>
8447 <sect1>
8448 <heading>Packages providing an X server</heading>
8451 Packages that provide an X server that, directly or
8452 indirectly, communicates with real input and display
8453 hardware should declare in their control data that they
8454 provide the virtual package <tt>xserver</tt>.<footnote>
8455 This implements current practice, and provides an
8456 actual policy for usage of the <tt>xserver</tt>
8457 virtual package which appears in the virtual packages
8458 list. In a nutshell, X servers that interface
8459 directly with the display and input hardware or via
8460 another subsystem (e.g., GGI) should provide
8461 <tt>xserver</tt>. Things like <tt>Xvfb</tt>,
8462 <tt>Xnest</tt>, and <tt>Xprt</tt> should not.
8463 </footnote>
8464 </p>
8465 </sect1>
8467 <sect1>
8468 <heading>Packages providing a terminal emulator</heading>
8471 Packages that provide a terminal emulator for the X Window
8472 System which meet the criteria listed below should declare
8473 in their control data that they provide the virtual
8474 package <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>. They should also
8475 register themselves as an alternative for
8476 <file>/usr/bin/x-terminal-emulator</file>, with a priority of
8478 </p>
8481 To be an <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>, a program must:
8482 <list compact="compact">
8483 <item>
8484 Be able to emulate a DEC VT100 terminal, or a
8485 compatible terminal.
8486 </item>
8488 <item>
8489 Support the command-line option <tt>-e
8490 <var>command</var></tt>, which creates a new
8491 terminal window<footnote>
8492 "New terminal window" does not necessarily mean
8493 a new top-level X window directly parented by
8494 the window manager; it could, if the terminal
8495 emulator application were so coded, be a new
8496 "view" in a multiple-document interface (MDI).
8497 </footnote>
8498 and runs the specified <var>command</var>,
8499 interpreting the entirety of the rest of the command
8500 line as a command to pass straight to exec, in the
8501 manner that <tt>xterm</tt> does.
8502 </item>
8504 <item>
8505 Support the command-line option <tt>-T
8506 <var>title</var></tt>, which creates a new terminal
8507 window with the window title <var>title</var>.
8508 </item>
8509 </list>
8510 </p>
8511 </sect1>
8513 <sect1>
8514 <heading>Packages providing a window manager</heading>
8517 Packages that provide a window manager should declare in
8518 their control data that they provide the virtual package
8519 <tt>x-window-manager</tt>. They should also register
8520 themselves as an alternative for
8521 <file>/usr/bin/x-window-manager</file>, with a priority
8522 calculated as follows:
8523 <list compact="compact">
8524 <item>
8525 Start with a priority of 20.
8526 </item>
8528 <item>
8529 If the window manager supports the Debian menu
8530 system, add 20 points if this support is available
8531 in the package's default configuration (i.e., no
8532 configuration files belonging to the system or user
8533 have to be edited to activate the feature); if
8534 configuration files must be modified, add only 10
8535 points.
8536 </p>
8537 </item>
8539 <item>
8540 If the window manager complies with <url
8541 id="http://www.freedesktop.org/Standards/wm-spec"
8542 name="The Window Manager Specification Project">,
8543 written by the <url id="http://www.freedesktop.org/"
8544 name="Free Desktop Group">, add 40 points.
8545 </item>
8547 <item>
8548 If the window manager permits the X session to be
8549 restarted using a <em>different</em> window manager
8550 (without killing the X server) in its default
8551 configuration, add 10 points; otherwise add none.
8552 </item>
8553 </list>
8554 </p>
8555 </sect1>
8557 <sect1>
8558 <heading>Packages providing fonts</heading>
8561 Packages that provide fonts for the X Window
8562 System<footnote>
8563 For the purposes of Debian Policy, a "font for the X
8564 Window System" is one which is accessed via X protocol
8565 requests. Fonts for the Linux console, for PostScript
8566 renderer, or any other purpose, do not fit this
8567 definition. Any tool which makes such fonts available
8568 to the X Window System, however, must abide by this
8569 font policy.
8570 </footnote>
8571 must do a number of things to ensure that they are both
8572 available without modification of the X or font server
8573 configuration, and that they do not corrupt files used by
8574 other font packages to register information about
8575 themselves.
8576 <enumlist>
8577 <item>
8578 Fonts of any type supported by the X Window System
8579 must be in a separate binary package from any
8580 executables, libraries, or documentation (except
8581 that specific to the fonts shipped, such as their
8582 license information). If one or more of the fonts
8583 so packaged are necessary for proper operation of
8584 the package with which they are associated the font
8585 package may be Recommended; if the fonts merely
8586 provide an enhancement, a Suggests relationship may
8587 be used. Packages must not Depend on font
8588 packages.<footnote>
8589 This is because the X server may retrieve fonts
8590 from the local file system or over the network
8591 from an X font server; the Debian package system
8592 is empowered to deal only with the local
8593 file system.
8594 </footnote>
8595 </item>
8597 <item>
8598 BDF fonts must be converted to PCF fonts with the
8599 <prgn>bdftopcf</prgn> utility (available in the
8600 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> package, <prgn>gzip</prgn>ped, and
8601 placed in a directory that corresponds to their
8602 resolution:
8603 <list compact="compact">
8604 <item>
8605 100 dpi fonts must be placed in
8606 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/100dpi/</file>.
8607 </item>
8609 <item>
8610 75 dpi fonts must be placed in
8611 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/75dpi/</file>.
8612 </item>
8614 <item>
8615 Character-cell fonts, cursor fonts, and other
8616 low-resolution fonts must be placed in
8617 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/misc/</file>.
8618 </item>
8619 </list>
8620 </item>
8622 <item>
8623 Type 1 fonts must be placed in
8624 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/Type1/</file>. If font
8625 metric files are available, they must be placed here
8626 as well.
8627 </item>
8629 <item>
8630 Subdirectories of <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file>
8631 other than those listed above must be neither
8632 created nor used. (The <file>PEX</file>, <file>CID</file>,
8633 <file>Speedo</file>, and <file>cyrillic</file> directories
8634 are excepted for historical reasons, but installation of
8635 files into these directories remains discouraged.)
8636 </item>
8638 <item>
8639 Font packages may, instead of placing files directly
8640 in the X font directories listed above, provide
8641 symbolic links in that font directory pointing to
8642 the files' actual location in the filesystem. Such
8643 a location must comply with the FHS.
8644 </item>
8646 <item>
8647 Font packages should not contain both 75dpi and
8648 100dpi versions of a font. If both are available,
8649 they should be provided in separate binary packages
8650 with <tt>-75dpi</tt> or <tt>-100dpi</tt> appended to
8651 the names of the packages containing the
8652 corresponding fonts.
8653 </item>
8655 <item>
8656 Fonts destined for the <file>misc</file> subdirectory
8657 should not be included in the same package as 75dpi
8658 or 100dpi fonts; instead, they should be provided in
8659 a separate package with <tt>-misc</tt> appended to
8660 its name.
8661 </item>
8663 <item>
8664 Font packages must not provide the files
8665 <file>fonts.dir</file>, <file>fonts.alias</file>, or
8666 <file>fonts.scale</file> in a font directory:
8667 <list>
8668 <item>
8669 <file>fonts.dir</file> files must not be provided at all.
8670 </item>
8672 <item>
8673 <file>fonts.alias</file> and <file>fonts.scale</file>
8674 files, if needed, should be provided in the
8675 directory
8676 <file>/etc/X11/fonts/<var>fontdir</var>/<var>package</var>.<var>extension</var></file>,
8677 where <var>fontdir</var> is the name of the
8678 subdirectory of
8679 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file> where the
8680 package's corresponding fonts are stored
8681 (e.g., <tt>75dpi</tt> or <tt>misc</tt>),
8682 <var>package</var> is the name of the package
8683 that provides these fonts, and
8684 <var>extension</var> is either <tt>scale</tt>
8685 or <tt>alias</tt>, whichever corresponds to
8686 the file contents.
8687 </item>
8688 </list>
8689 </item>
8691 <item>
8692 Font packages must declare a dependency on
8693 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> in their control
8694 data.
8695 </item>
8697 <item>
8698 Font packages that provide one or more
8699 <file>fonts.scale</file> files as described above must
8700 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-scale</prgn> on each
8701 directory into which they installed fonts
8702 <em>before</em> invoking
8703 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on that directory.
8704 This invocation must occur in both the
8705 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8706 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8707 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8708 </item>
8710 <item>
8711 Font packages that provide one or more
8712 <file>fonts.alias</file> files as described above must
8713 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-alias</prgn> on each
8714 directory into which they installed fonts. This
8715 invocation must occur in both the
8716 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8717 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8718 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8719 </item>
8721 <item>
8722 Font packages must invoke
8723 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on each directory into
8724 which they installed fonts. This invocation must
8725 occur in both the <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all
8726 arguments) and <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all
8727 arguments except <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8728 </item>
8730 <item>
8731 Font packages must not provide alias names for the
8732 fonts they include which collide with alias names
8733 already in use by fonts already packaged.
8734 </item>
8736 <item>
8737 Font packages must not provide fonts with the same
8738 XLFD registry name as another font already packaged.
8739 </item>
8740 </enumlist>
8741 </p>
8742 </sect1>
8744 <sect1 id="appdefaults">
8745 <heading>Application defaults files</heading>
8748 Application defaults files must be installed in the
8749 directory <file>/etc/X11/app-defaults/</file> (use of a
8750 localized subdirectory of <file>/etc/X11/</file> as described
8751 in the <em>X Toolkit Intrinsics - C Language
8752 Interface</em> manual is also permitted). They must be
8753 registered as <tt>conffile</tt>s or handled as
8754 configuration files.
8755 </p>
8758 Customization of programs' X resources may also be
8759 supported with the provision of a file with the same name
8760 as that of the package placed in
8761 the <file>/etc/X11/Xresources/</file> directory, which
8762 must be registered as a <tt>conffile</tt> or handled as a
8763 configuration file.<footnote>
8764 Note that this mechanism is not the same as using
8765 app-defaults; app-defaults are tied to the client
8766 binary on the local file system, whereas X resources
8767 are stored in the X server and affect all connecting
8768 clients.
8769 </footnote>
8770 </p>
8771 </sect1>
8773 <sect1>
8774 <heading>Installation directory issues</heading>
8777 Historically, packages using the X Window System used a
8778 separate set of installation directories from other packages.
8779 This practice has been discontinued and packages using the X
8780 Window System should now generally be installed in the same
8781 directories as any other package. Specifically, packages must
8782 not install files under the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory
8783 and the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory hierarchy should be
8784 regarded as obsolete.
8785 </p>
8788 Include files previously installed under
8789 <file>/usr/X11R6/include/X11/</file> should be installed into
8790 <file>/usr/include/X11/</file>. For files previously
8791 installed into subdirectories of
8792 <file>/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/</file>, package maintainers should
8793 determine if subdirectories of <file>/usr/lib/</file> and
8794 <file>/usr/share/</file> can be used. If not, a subdirectory
8795 of <file>/usr/lib/X11/</file> should be used.
8796 </p>
8799 Configuration files for window, display, or session managers
8800 or other applications that are tightly integrated with the X
8801 Window System may be placed in a subdirectory
8802 of <file>/etc/X11/</file> corresponding to the package name.
8803 Other X Window System applications should use
8804 the <file>/etc/</file> directory unless otherwise mandated by
8805 policy (such as for <ref id="appdefaults">).
8806 </p>
8807 </sect1>
8809 <sect1>
8810 <heading>The OSF/Motif and OpenMotif libraries</heading>
8813 <em>Programs that require the non-DFSG-compliant OSF/Motif or
8814 OpenMotif libraries</em><footnote>
8815 OSF/Motif and OpenMotif are collectively referred to as
8816 "Motif" in this policy document.
8817 </footnote>
8818 should be compiled against and tested with LessTif (a free
8819 re-implementation of Motif) instead. If the maintainer
8820 judges that the program or programs do not work
8821 sufficiently well with LessTif to be distributed and
8822 supported, but do so when compiled against Motif, then two
8823 versions of the package should be created; one linked
8824 statically against Motif and with <tt>-smotif</tt>
8825 appended to the package name, and one linked dynamically
8826 against Motif and with <tt>-dmotif</tt> appended to the
8827 package name.
8828 </p>
8831 Both Motif-linked versions are dependent
8832 upon non-DFSG-compliant software and thus cannot be
8833 uploaded to the <em>main</em> distribution; if the
8834 software is itself DFSG-compliant it may be uploaded to
8835 the <em>contrib</em> distribution. While known existing
8836 versions of Motif permit unlimited redistribution of
8837 binaries linked against the library (whether statically or
8838 dynamically), it is the package maintainer's
8839 responsibility to determine whether this is permitted by
8840 the license of the copy of Motif in their possession.
8841 </p>
8842 </sect1>
8843 </sect>
8845 <sect id="perl">
8846 <heading>Perl programs and modules</heading>
8849 Perl programs and modules should follow the current Perl policy.
8850 </p>
8853 The Perl policy can be found in the <tt>perl-policy</tt>
8854 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
8855 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
8856 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"
8857 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"></tt>.
8858 </p>
8859 </sect>
8861 <sect id="emacs">
8862 <heading>Emacs lisp programs</heading>
8865 Please refer to the "Debian Emacs Policy" for details of how to
8866 package emacs lisp programs.
8867 </p>
8870 The Emacs policy is available in
8871 <file>debian-emacs-policy.gz</file> of the
8872 <package>emacsen-common</package> package.
8873 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
8874 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"
8875 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"></tt>.
8876 </p>
8877 </sect>
8879 <sect>
8880 <heading>Games</heading>
8883 The permissions on <file>/var/games</file> are mode 755, owner
8884 <tt>root</tt> and group <tt>root</tt>.
8885 </p>
8888 Each game decides on its own security policy.</p>
8891 Games which require protected, privileged access to
8892 high-score files, saved games, etc., may be made
8893 set-<em>group</em>-id (mode 2755) and owned by
8894 <tt>root:games</tt>, and use files and directories with
8895 appropriate permissions (770 <tt>root:games</tt>, for
8896 example). They must not be made
8897 set-<em>user</em>-id, as this causes security problems. (If
8898 an attacker can subvert any set-user-id game they can
8899 overwrite the executable of any other, causing other players
8900 of these games to run a Trojan horse program. With a
8901 set-group-id game the attacker only gets access to less
8902 important game data, and if they can get at the other
8903 players' accounts at all it will take considerably more
8904 effort.)</p>
8907 Some packages, for example some fortune cookie programs, are
8908 configured by the upstream authors to install with their
8909 data files or other static information made unreadable so
8910 that they can only be accessed through set-id programs
8911 provided. You should not do this in a Debian package: anyone can
8912 download the <file>.deb</file> file and read the data from it,
8913 so there is no point making the files unreadable. Not
8914 making the files unreadable also means that you don't have
8915 to make so many programs set-id, which reduces the risk of a
8916 security hole.</p>
8919 As described in the FHS, binaries of games should be
8920 installed in the directory <file>/usr/games</file>. This also
8921 applies to games that use the X Window System. Manual pages
8922 for games (X and non-X games) should be installed in
8923 <file>/usr/share/man/man6</file>.</p>
8924 </sect>
8925 </chapt>
8928 <chapt id="docs">
8929 <heading>Documentation</heading>
8931 <sect>
8932 <heading>Manual pages</heading>
8935 You should install manual pages in <prgn>nroff</prgn> source
8936 form, in appropriate places under <file>/usr/share/man</file>.
8937 You should only use sections 1 to 9 (see the FHS for more
8938 details). You must not install a pre-formatted "cat page".
8939 </p>
8942 Each program, utility, and function should have an
8943 associated manual page included in the same package. It is
8944 suggested that all configuration files also have a manual
8945 page included as well. Manual pages for protocols and other
8946 auxiliary things are optional.
8947 </p>
8950 If no manual page is available, this is considered as a bug
8951 and should be reported to the Debian Bug Tracking System (the
8952 maintainer of the package is allowed to write this bug report
8953 themselves, if they so desire). Do not close the bug report
8954 until a proper man page is available.<footnote>
8955 It is not very hard to write a man page. See the
8956 <url id="http://www.schweikhardt.net/man_page_howto.html"
8957 name="Man-Page-HOWTO">,
8958 <manref name="man" section="7">, the examples
8959 created by <prgn>debmake</prgn> or <prgn>dh_make</prgn>,
8960 the helper program <prgn>help2man</prgn>, or the
8961 directory <file>/usr/share/doc/man-db/examples</file>.
8962 </footnote>
8963 </p>
8966 You may forward a complaint about a missing man page to the
8967 upstream authors, and mark the bug as forwarded in the
8968 Debian bug tracking system. Even though the GNU Project do
8969 not in general consider the lack of a man page to be a bug,
8970 we do; if they tell you that they don't consider it a bug
8971 you should leave the bug in our bug tracking system open
8972 anyway.
8973 </p>
8976 Manual pages should be installed compressed using <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
8977 </p>
8980 If one man page needs to be accessible via several names it
8981 is better to use a symbolic link than the <file>.so</file>
8982 feature, but there is no need to fiddle with the relevant
8983 parts of the upstream source to change from <file>.so</file> to
8984 symlinks: don't do it unless it's easy. You should not
8985 create hard links in the manual page directories, nor put
8986 absolute filenames in <file>.so</file> directives. The filename
8987 in a <file>.so</file> in a man page should be relative to the
8988 base of the man page tree (usually
8989 <file>/usr/share/man</file>). If you do not create any links
8990 (whether symlinks, hard links, or <tt>.so</tt> directives)
8991 in the file system to the alternate names of the man page,
8992 then you should not rely on <prgn>man</prgn> finding your
8993 man page under those names based solely on the information in
8994 the man page's header.<footnote>
8995 Supporting this in <prgn>man</prgn> often requires
8996 unreasonable processing time to find a manual page or to
8997 report that none exists, and moves knowledge into man's
8998 database that would be better left in the file system.
8999 This support is therefore deprecated and will cease to
9000 be present in the future.
9001 </footnote>
9002 </p>
9005 Manual pages in locale-specific subdirectories of
9006 <file>/usr/share/man</file> should use either UTF-8 or the usual
9007 legacy encoding for that language (normally the one corresponding
9008 to the shortest relevant locale name in
9009 <file>/usr/share/i18n/SUPPORTED</file>). For example, pages under
9010 <file>/usr/share/man/fr</file> should use either UTF-8 or
9011 ISO-8859-1.<footnote>
9012 <prgn>man</prgn> will automatically detect whether UTF-8 is in
9013 use. In future, all manual pages will be required to use
9014 UTF-8.
9015 </footnote>
9016 </p>
9019 A country name (the <tt>DE</tt> in <tt>de_DE</tt>) should not be
9020 included in the subdirectory name unless it indicates a
9021 significant difference in the language, as this excludes
9022 speakers of the language in other countries.<footnote>
9023 At the time of writing, Chinese and Portuguese are the main
9024 languages with such differences, so <file>pt_BR</file>,
9025 <file>zh_CN</file>, and <file>zh_TW</file> are all allowed.
9026 </footnote>
9027 </p>
9030 If a localized version of a manual page is provided, it should
9031 either be up-to-date or it should be obvious to the reader that
9032 it is outdated and the original manual page should be used
9033 instead. This can be done either by a note at the beginning of
9034 the manual page or by showing the missing or changed portions in
9035 the original language instead of the target language.
9036 </p>
9037 </sect>
9039 <sect>
9040 <heading>Info documents</heading>
9043 Info documents should be installed in <file>/usr/share/info</file>.
9044 They should be compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
9045 </p>
9048 The <prgn>install-info</prgn> program maintains a directory of
9049 installed info documents in <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> for
9050 the use of info readers.<footnote>
9051 It was previously necessary for packages installing info
9052 documents to run <prgn>install-info</prgn> from maintainer
9053 scripts. This is no longer necessary. The installation
9054 system now uses dpkg triggers.
9055 </footnote>
9056 This file must not be included in packages. Packages containing
9057 info documents should depend on <tt>dpkg (>= 1.15.4) |
9058 install-info</tt> to ensure that the directory file is properly
9059 rebuilt during partial upgrades from Debian 5.0 (lenny) and
9060 earlier.
9061 </p>
9064 Info documents should contain section and directory entry
9065 information in the document for the use
9066 of <prgn>install-info</prgn>. The section should be specified
9067 via a line starting with <tt>INFO-DIR-SECTION</tt> followed by a
9068 space and the section of this info page. The directory entry or
9069 entries should be included between
9070 a <tt>START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line and
9071 an <tt>END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line. For example:
9072 <example>
9073 INFO-DIR-SECTION Individual utilities
9074 START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
9075 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
9076 END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
9077 </example>
9078 To determine which section to use, you should look
9079 at <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> on your system and choose
9080 the most relevant (or create a new section if none of the
9081 current sections are relevant).<footnote>
9082 Normally, info documents are generated from Texinfo source.
9083 To include this information in the generated info document, if
9084 it is absent, add commands like:
9085 <example>
9086 @dircategory Individual utilities
9087 @direntry
9088 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
9089 @end direntry
9090 </example>
9091 to the Texinfo source of the document and ensure that the info
9092 documents are rebuilt from source during the package build.
9093 </footnote>
9094 </p>
9095 </sect>
9097 <sect>
9098 <heading>Additional documentation</heading>
9101 Any additional documentation that comes with the package may
9102 be installed at the discretion of the package maintainer.
9103 Plain text documentation should be installed in the directory
9104 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>, where
9105 <var>package</var> is the name of the package, and
9106 compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt> unless it is small.
9107 </p>
9110 If a package comes with large amounts of documentation which
9111 many users of the package will not require you should create
9112 a separate binary package to contain it, so that it does not
9113 take up disk space on the machines of users who do not need
9114 or want it installed.</p>
9117 It is often a good idea to put text information files
9118 (<file>README</file>s, changelogs, and so forth) that come with
9119 the source package in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
9120 in the binary package. However, you don't need to install
9121 the instructions for building and installing the package, of
9122 course!</p>
9125 Packages must not require the existence of any files in
9126 <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> in order to function
9127 <footnote>
9128 The system administrator should be able to
9129 delete files in <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> without causing
9130 any programs to break.
9131 </footnote>.
9132 Any files that are referenced by programs but are also
9133 useful as stand alone documentation should be installed under
9134 <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/</file> with symbolic links from
9135 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9136 </p>
9139 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9140 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9141 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9142 first package Depends on the second.<footnote>
9144 Please note that this does not override the section on
9145 changelog files below, so the file
9146 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.Debian.gz</file>
9147 must refer to the changelog for the current version of
9148 <var>package</var> in question. In practice, this means
9149 that the sources of the target and the destination of the
9150 symlink must be the same (same source package and
9151 version).
9152 </p>
9153 </footnote>
9154 </p>
9157 Former Debian releases placed all additional documentation
9158 in <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. This has been
9159 changed to <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>,
9160 and packages must not put documentation in the directory
9161 <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. <footnote>
9162 At this phase of the transition, we no longer require a
9163 symbolic link in <file>/usr/doc/</file>. At a later point,
9164 policy shall change to make the symbolic links a bug.
9165 </footnote>
9166 </p>
9167 </sect>
9169 <sect>
9170 <heading>Preferred documentation formats</heading>
9173 The unification of Debian documentation is being carried out
9174 via HTML.</p>
9177 If your package comes with extensive documentation in a
9178 markup format that can be converted to various other formats
9179 you should if possible ship HTML versions in a binary
9180 package, in the directory
9181 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>appropriate-package</var></file> or
9182 its subdirectories.<footnote>
9183 The rationale: The important thing here is that HTML
9184 docs should be available in <em>some</em> package, not
9185 necessarily in the main binary package.
9186 </footnote>
9187 </p>
9190 Other formats such as PostScript may be provided at the
9191 package maintainer's discretion.
9192 </p>
9193 </sect>
9195 <sect id="copyrightfile">
9196 <heading>Copyright information</heading>
9199 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
9200 copyright information and distribution license in the file
9201 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>. This
9202 file must neither be compressed nor be a symbolic link.
9203 </p>
9206 In addition, the copyright file must say where the upstream
9207 sources (if any) were obtained. It should name the original
9208 authors of the package and the Debian maintainer(s) who were
9209 involved with its creation.
9210 </p>
9213 Packages in the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em> archive
9214 areas should state in the copyright file that the package is not
9215 part of the Debian GNU/Linux distribution and briefly explain
9216 why.
9217 </p>
9220 A copy of the file which will be installed in
9221 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file> should
9222 be in <file>debian/copyright</file> in the source package.
9223 </p>
9226 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9227 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9228 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9229 first package Depends on the second. These rules are
9230 important because copyrights must be extractable by
9231 mechanical means.
9232 </p>
9235 Packages distributed under the UCB BSD license, the Apache
9236 license (version 2.0), the Artistic license, the GNU GPL
9237 (version 2 or 3), the GNU LGPL (versions 2, 2.1, or 3), and the
9238 GNU FDL (versions 1.2 or 1.3) should refer to the corresponding
9239 files under <file>/usr/share/common-licenses</file>,<footnote>
9241 In particular,
9242 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/BSD</file>,
9243 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Apache-2.0</file>,
9244 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Artistic</file>,
9245 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-2</file>,
9246 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-3</file>,
9247 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2</file>,
9248 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2.1</file>,
9249 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-3</file>,
9250 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.2</file>, and
9251 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.3</file>
9252 respectively.
9253 </p>
9254 </footnote> rather than quoting them in the copyright
9255 file.
9256 </p>
9259 You should not use the copyright file as a general <file>README</file>
9260 file. If your package has such a file it should be
9261 installed in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/README</file> or
9262 <file>README.Debian</file> or some other appropriate place.</p>
9263 </sect>
9265 <sect>
9266 <heading>Examples</heading>
9269 Any examples (configurations, source files, whatever),
9270 should be installed in a directory
9271 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>. These
9272 files should not be referenced by any program: they're there
9273 for the benefit of the system administrator and users as
9274 documentation only. Architecture-specific example files
9275 should be installed in a directory
9276 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var>/examples</file> with symbolic
9277 links to them from
9278 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>, or the
9279 latter directory itself may be a symbolic link to the
9280 former.
9281 </p>
9284 If the purpose of a package is to provide examples, then the
9285 example files may be installed into
9286 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9287 </p>
9288 </sect>
9290 <sect id="changelogs">
9291 <heading>Changelog files</heading>
9294 Packages that are not Debian-native must contain a
9295 compressed copy of the <file>debian/changelog</file> file from
9296 the Debian source tree in
9297 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> with the name
9298 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9299 </p>
9302 If an upstream changelog is available, it should be accessible as
9303 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file> in
9304 plain text. If the upstream changelog is distributed in
9305 HTML, it should be made available in that form as
9306 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.html.gz</file>
9307 and a plain text <file>changelog.gz</file> should be generated
9308 from it using, for example, <tt>lynx -dump -nolist</tt>. If
9309 the upstream changelog files do not already conform to this
9310 naming convention, then this may be achieved either by
9311 renaming the files, or by adding a symbolic link, at the
9312 maintainer's discretion.<footnote>
9313 Rationale: People should not have to look in places for
9314 upstream changelogs merely because they are given
9315 different names or are distributed in HTML format.
9316 </footnote>
9317 </p>
9320 All of these files should be installed compressed using
9321 <tt>gzip -9</tt>, as they will become large with time even
9322 if they start out small.
9323 </p>
9326 If the package has only one changelog which is used both as
9327 the Debian changelog and the upstream one because there is
9328 no separate upstream maintainer then that changelog should
9329 usually be installed as
9330 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file>; if
9331 there is a separate upstream maintainer, but no upstream
9332 changelog, then the Debian changelog should still be called
9333 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9334 </p>
9337 For details about the format and contents of the Debian
9338 changelog file, please see <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
9339 </p>
9340 </sect>
9341 </chapt>
9343 <appendix id="pkg-scope">
9344 <heading>Introduction and scope of these appendices</heading>
9347 These appendices are taken essentially verbatim from the
9348 now-deprecated Packaging Manual, version 3.2.1.0. They are
9349 the chapters which are likely to be of use to package
9350 maintainers and which have not already been included in the
9351 policy document itself. Most of these sections are very likely
9352 not relevant to policy; they should be treated as
9353 documentation for the packaging system. Please note that these
9354 appendices are included for convenience, and for historical
9355 reasons: they used to be part of policy package, and they have
9356 not yet been incorporated into dpkg documentation. However,
9357 they still have value, and hence they are presented here.
9358 </p>
9361 They have not yet been checked to ensure that they are
9362 compatible with the contents of policy, and if there are any
9363 contradictions, the version in the main policy document takes
9364 precedence. The remaining chapters of the old Packaging
9365 Manual have also not been read in detail to ensure that there
9366 are not parts which have been left out. Both of these will be
9367 done in due course.
9368 </p>
9371 Certain parts of the Packaging manual were integrated into the
9372 Policy Manual proper, and removed from the appendices. Links
9373 have been placed from the old locations to the new ones.
9374 </p>
9377 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is a suite of programs for creating binary
9378 package files and installing and removing them on Unix
9379 systems.<footnote>
9380 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is targeted primarily at Debian
9381 GNU/Linux, but may work on or be ported to other
9382 systems.
9383 </footnote>
9384 </p>
9387 The binary packages are designed for the management of
9388 installed executable programs (usually compiled binaries) and
9389 their associated data, though source code examples and
9390 documentation are provided as part of some packages.</p>
9393 This manual describes the technical aspects of creating Debian
9394 binary packages (<file>.deb</file> files). It documents the
9395 behavior of the package management programs
9396 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, <prgn>dselect</prgn> et al. and the way
9397 they interact with packages.</p>
9400 It also documents the interaction between
9401 <prgn>dselect</prgn>'s core and the access method scripts it
9402 uses to actually install the selected packages, and describes
9403 how to create a new access method.</p>
9406 This manual does not go into detail about the options and
9407 usage of the package building and installation tools. It
9408 should therefore be read in conjunction with those programs'
9409 man pages.
9410 </p>
9413 The utility programs which are provided with <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9414 for managing various system configuration and similar issues,
9415 such as <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and
9416 <prgn>install-info</prgn>, are not described in detail here -
9417 please see their man pages.
9418 </p>
9421 It is assumed that the reader is reasonably familiar with the
9422 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> System Administrators' manual.
9423 Unfortunately this manual does not yet exist.
9424 </p>
9427 The Debian version of the FSF's GNU hello program is provided
9428 as an example for people wishing to create Debian
9429 packages. The Debian <prgn>debmake</prgn> package is
9430 recommended as a very helpful tool in creating and maintaining
9431 Debian packages. However, while the tools and examples are
9432 helpful, they do not replace the need to read and follow the
9433 Policy and Programmer's Manual.</p>
9434 </appendix>
9436 <appendix id="pkg-binarypkg">
9437 <heading>Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
9440 The binary package has two main sections. The first part
9441 consists of various control information files and scripts used
9442 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when installing and removing. See <ref
9443 id="pkg-controlarea">.
9444 </p>
9447 The second part is an archive containing the files and
9448 directories to be installed.
9449 </p>
9452 In the future binary packages may also contain other
9453 components, such as checksums and digital signatures. The
9454 format for the archive is described in full in the
9455 <file>deb(5)</file> man page.
9456 </p>
9459 <sect id="pkg-bincreating"><heading>Creating package files -
9460 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>
9461 </heading>
9464 All manipulation of binary package files is done by
9465 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>; it's the only program that has
9466 knowledge of the format. (<prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> may be
9467 invoked by calling <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, as <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9468 will spot that the options requested are appropriate to
9469 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> and invoke that instead with the same
9470 arguments.)
9471 </p>
9474 In order to create a binary package you must make a
9475 directory tree which contains all the files and directories
9476 you want to have in the file system data part of the package.
9477 In Debian-format source packages this directory is usually
9478 <file>debian/tmp</file>, relative to the top of the package's
9479 source tree.
9480 </p>
9483 They should have the locations (relative to the root of the
9484 directory tree you're constructing) ownerships and
9485 permissions which you want them to have on the system when
9486 they are installed.
9487 </p>
9490 With current versions of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> the uid/username
9491 and gid/groupname mappings for the users and groups being
9492 used should be the same on the system where the package is
9493 built and the one where it is installed.
9494 </p>
9497 You need to add one special directory to the root of the
9498 miniature file system tree you're creating:
9499 <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn>. It should contain the control
9500 information files, notably the binary package control file
9501 (see <ref id="pkg-controlfile">).
9502 </p>
9505 The <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn> directory will not appear in the
9506 file system archive of the package, and so won't be installed
9507 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when the package is installed.
9508 </p>
9511 When you've prepared the package, you should invoke:
9512 <example>
9513 dpkg --build <var>directory</var>
9514 </example>
9515 </p>
9518 This will build the package in
9519 <file><var>directory</var>.deb</file>. (<prgn>dpkg</prgn> knows
9520 that <tt>--build</tt> is a <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> option, so
9521 it invokes <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> with the same arguments to
9522 build the package.)
9523 </p>
9526 See the man page <manref name="dpkg-deb" section="8"> for details of how
9527 to examine the contents of this newly-created file. You may find the
9528 output of following commands enlightening:
9529 <example>
9530 dpkg-deb --info <var>filename</var>.deb
9531 dpkg-deb --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9532 dpkg --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9533 </example>
9534 To view the copyright file for a package you could use this command:
9535 <example>
9536 dpkg --fsys-tarfile <var>filename</var>.deb | tar xOf - --wildcards \*/copyright | pager
9537 </example>
9538 </p>
9539 </sect>
9541 <sect id="pkg-controlarea">
9542 <heading>Package control information files</heading>
9545 The control information portion of a binary package is a
9546 collection of files with names known to <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
9547 It will treat the contents of these files specially - some
9548 of them contain information used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when
9549 installing or removing the package; others are scripts which
9550 the package maintainer wants <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to run.
9551 </p>
9554 It is possible to put other files in the package control
9555 area, but this is not generally a good idea (though they
9556 will largely be ignored).
9557 </p>
9560 Here is a brief list of the control info files supported by
9561 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and a summary of what they're used for.
9562 </p>
9565 <taglist>
9566 <tag><tt>control</tt>
9567 <item>
9569 This is the key description file used by
9570 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. It specifies the package's name
9571 and version, gives its description for the user,
9572 states its relationships with other packages, and so
9573 forth. See <ref id="sourcecontrolfiles"> and
9574 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9575 </p>
9578 It is usually generated automatically from information
9579 in the source package by the
9580 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> program, and with
9581 assistance from <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
9582 See <ref id="pkg-sourcetools">.
9583 </p>
9584 </item>
9586 <tag><tt>postinst</tt>, <tt>preinst</tt>, <tt>postrm</tt>,
9587 <tt>prerm</tt>
9588 </tag>
9589 <item>
9591 These are executable files (usually scripts) which
9592 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> runs during installation, upgrade
9593 and removal of packages. They allow the package to
9594 deal with matters which are particular to that package
9595 or require more complicated processing than that
9596 provided by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Details of when and
9597 how they are called are in <ref id="maintainerscripts">.
9598 </p>
9601 It is very important to make these scripts idempotent.
9602 See <ref id="idempotency">.
9603 </p>
9606 The maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a
9607 controlling terminal and may not be able to interact with
9608 the user. See <ref id="controllingterminal">.
9609 </p>
9610 </item>
9612 <tag><tt>conffiles</tt>
9613 </tag>
9614 <item>
9615 This file contains a list of configuration files which
9616 are to be handled automatically by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9617 (see <ref id="pkg-conffiles">). Note that not necessarily
9618 every configuration file should be listed here.
9619 </item>
9621 <tag><tt>shlibs</tt>
9622 </tag>
9623 <item>
9624 This file contains a list of the shared libraries
9625 supplied by the package, with dependency details for
9626 each. This is used by <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
9627 when it determines what dependencies are required in a
9628 package control file. The <tt>shlibs</tt> file format
9629 is described on <ref id="shlibs">.
9630 </item>
9631 </taglist>
9632 </p>
9634 <sect id="pkg-controlfile">
9635 <heading>The main control information file: <tt>control</tt></heading>
9638 The most important control information file used by
9639 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when it installs a package is
9640 <tt>control</tt>. It contains all the package's "vital
9641 statistics".
9642 </p>
9645 The binary package control files of packages built from
9646 Debian sources are made by a special tool,
9647 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>, which reads
9648 <file>debian/control</file> and <file>debian/changelog</file> to
9649 find the information it needs. See <ref id="pkg-sourcepkg"> for
9650 more details.
9651 </p>
9654 The fields in binary package control files are listed in
9655 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9656 </p>
9659 A description of the syntax of control files and the purpose
9660 of the fields is available in <ref id="controlfields">.
9661 </p>
9662 </sect>
9664 <sect>
9665 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
9668 See <ref id="timestamps">.
9669 </p>
9670 </sect>
9671 </appendix>
9673 <appendix id="pkg-sourcepkg">
9674 <heading>Source packages (from old Packaging Manual) </heading>
9677 The Debian binary packages in the distribution are generated
9678 from Debian sources, which are in a special format to assist
9679 the easy and automatic building of binaries.
9680 </p>
9682 <sect id="pkg-sourcetools">
9683 <heading>Tools for processing source packages</heading>
9686 Various tools are provided for manipulating source packages;
9687 they pack and unpack sources and help build of binary
9688 packages and help manage the distribution of new versions.
9689 </p>
9692 They are introduced and typical uses described here; see
9693 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1"> for full
9694 documentation about their arguments and operation.
9695 </p>
9698 For examples of how to construct a Debian source package,
9699 and how to use those utilities that are used by Debian
9700 source packages, please see the <prgn>hello</prgn> example
9701 package.
9702 </p>
9704 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-source">
9705 <heading>
9706 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - packs and unpacks Debian source
9707 packages
9708 </heading>
9711 This program is frequently used by hand, and is also
9712 called from package-independent automated building scripts
9713 such as <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>.
9714 </p>
9717 To unpack a package it is typically invoked with
9718 <example>
9719 dpkg-source -x <var>.../path/to/filename</var>.dsc
9720 </example>
9721 </p>
9724 with the <file><var>filename</var>.tar.gz</file> and
9725 <file><var>filename</var>.diff.gz</file> (if applicable) in
9726 the same directory. It unpacks into
9727 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>, and if
9728 applicable
9729 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var>.orig</file>, in
9730 the current directory.
9731 </p>
9734 To create a packed source archive it is typically invoked:
9735 <example>
9736 dpkg-source -b <var>package</var>-<var>version</var>
9737 </example>
9738 </p>
9741 This will create the <file>.dsc</file>, <file>.tar.gz</file> and
9742 <file>.diff.gz</file> (if appropriate) in the current
9743 directory. <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> does not clean the
9744 source tree first - this must be done separately if it is
9745 required.
9746 </p>
9749 See also <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.</p>
9750 </sect1>
9753 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-buildpackage">
9754 <heading>
9755 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> - overall package-building
9756 control script
9757 </heading>
9760 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> is a script which invokes
9761 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, the <file>debian/rules</file>
9762 targets <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build</tt> and
9763 <tt>binary</tt>, <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and
9764 <prgn>gpg</prgn> (or <prgn>pgp</prgn>) to build a signed
9765 source and binary package upload.
9766 </p>
9769 It is usually invoked by hand from the top level of the
9770 built or unbuilt source directory. It may be invoked with
9771 no arguments; useful arguments include:
9772 <taglist compact="compact">
9773 <tag><tt>-uc</tt>, <tt>-us</tt></tag>
9774 <item>
9776 Do not sign the <tt>.changes</tt> file or the
9777 source package <tt>.dsc</tt> file, respectively.</p>
9778 </item>
9779 <tag><tt>-p<var>sign-command</var></tt></tag>
9780 <item>
9782 Invoke <var>sign-command</var> instead of finding
9783 <tt>gpg</tt> or <tt>pgp</tt> on the <prgn>PATH</prgn>.
9784 <var>sign-command</var> must behave just like
9785 <prgn>gpg</prgn> or <tt>pgp</tt>.</p>
9786 </item>
9787 <tag><tt>-r<var>root-command</var></tt></tag>
9788 <item>
9790 When root privilege is required, invoke the command
9791 <var>root-command</var>. <var>root-command</var>
9792 should invoke its first argument as a command, from
9793 the <prgn>PATH</prgn> if necessary, and pass its
9794 second and subsequent arguments to the command it
9795 calls. If no <var>root-command</var> is supplied
9796 then <var>dpkg-buildpackage</var> will take no
9797 special action to gain root privilege, so that for
9798 most packages it will have to be invoked as root to
9799 start with.</p>
9800 </item>
9801 <tag><tt>-b</tt>, <tt>-B</tt></tag>
9802 <item>
9804 Two types of binary-only build and upload - see
9805 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1">.
9806 </p>
9807 </item>
9808 </taglist>
9809 </p>
9810 </sect1>
9812 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-gencontrol">
9813 <heading>
9814 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> - generates binary package
9815 control files
9816 </heading>
9819 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
9820 (see <ref id="pkg-sourcetree">) in the top level of the source
9821 tree.
9822 </p>
9825 This is usually done just before the files and directories in the
9826 temporary directory tree where the package is being built have their
9827 permissions and ownerships set and the package is constructed using
9828 <prgn>dpkg-deb/</prgn>
9829 <footnote>
9830 This is so that the control file which is produced has
9831 the right permissions
9832 </footnote>.
9833 </p>
9836 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> must be called after all the
9837 files which are to go into the package have been placed in
9838 the temporary build directory, so that its calculation of
9839 the installed size of a package is correct.
9840 </p>
9843 It is also necessary for <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
9844 be run after <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> so that the
9845 variable substitutions created by
9846 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> in <file>debian/substvars</file>
9847 are available.
9848 </p>
9851 For a package which generates only one binary package, and
9852 which builds it in <file>debian/tmp</file> relative to the top
9853 of the source package, it is usually sufficient to call
9854 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>.
9855 </p>
9858 Sources which build several binaries will typically need
9859 something like:
9860 <example>
9861 dpkg-gencontrol -Pdebian/tmp-<var>pkg</var> -p<var>package</var>
9862 </example> The <tt>-P</tt> tells
9863 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> that the package is being
9864 built in a non-default directory, and the <tt>-p</tt>
9865 tells it which package's control file should be generated.
9866 </p>
9869 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> also adds information to the
9870 list of files in <file>debian/files</file>, for the benefit of
9871 (for example) a future invocation of
9872 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn>.</p>
9873 </sect1>
9875 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps">
9876 <heading>
9877 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> - calculates shared library
9878 dependencies
9879 </heading>
9882 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
9883 just before <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> (see <ref
9884 id="pkg-sourcetree">), in the top level of the source tree.
9885 </p>
9888 Its arguments are executables and shared libraries
9889 <footnote>
9891 They may be specified either in the locations in the
9892 source tree where they are created or in the locations
9893 in the temporary build tree where they are installed
9894 prior to binary package creation.
9895 </p>
9896 </footnote> for which shared library dependencies should
9897 be included in the binary package's control file.
9898 </p>
9901 If some of the found shared libraries should only
9902 warrant a <tt>Recommends</tt> or <tt>Suggests</tt>, or if
9903 some warrant a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, this can be achieved
9904 by using the <tt>-d<var>dependency-field</var></tt> option
9905 before those executable(s). (Each <tt>-d</tt> option
9906 takes effect until the next <tt>-d</tt>.)
9907 </p>
9910 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> does not directly cause the
9911 output control file to be modified. Instead by default it
9912 adds to the <file>debian/substvars</file> file variable
9913 settings like <tt>shlibs:Depends</tt>. These variable
9914 settings must be referenced in dependency fields in the
9915 appropriate per-binary-package sections of the source
9916 control file.
9917 </p>
9920 For example, a package that generates an essential part
9921 which requires dependencies, and optional parts that
9922 which only require a recommendation, would separate those
9923 two sets of dependencies into two different fields.<footnote>
9924 At the time of writing, an example for this was the
9925 <package/xmms/ package, with Depends used for the xmms
9926 executable, Recommends for the plug-ins and Suggests for
9927 even more optional features provided by unzip.
9928 </footnote>
9929 It can say in its <file>debian/rules</file>:
9930 <example>
9931 dpkg-shlibdeps -dDepends <var>program anotherprogram ...</var> \
9932 -dRecommends <var>optionalpart anotheroptionalpart</var>
9933 </example>
9934 and then in its main control file <file>debian/control</file>:
9935 <example>
9936 <var>...</var>
9937 Depends: ${shlibs:Depends}
9938 Recommends: ${shlibs:Recommends}
9939 <var>...</var>
9940 </example>
9941 </p>
9944 Sources which produce several binary packages with
9945 different shared library dependency requirements can use
9946 the <tt>-p<var>varnameprefix</var></tt> option to override
9947 the default <tt>shlibs:</tt> prefix (one invocation of
9948 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> per setting of this option).
9949 They can thus produce several sets of dependency
9950 variables, each of the form
9951 <tt><var>varnameprefix</var>:<var>dependencyfield</var></tt>,
9952 which can be referred to in the appropriate parts of the
9953 binary package control files.
9954 </p>
9955 </sect1>
9958 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-distaddfile">
9959 <heading>
9960 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - adds a file to
9961 <file>debian/files</file>
9962 </heading>
9965 Some packages' uploads need to include files other than
9966 the source and binary package files.
9967 </p>
9970 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> adds a file to the
9971 <file>debian/files</file> file so that it will be included in
9972 the <file>.changes</file> file when
9973 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> is run.
9974 </p>
9977 It is usually invoked from the <tt>binary</tt> target of
9978 <file>debian/rules</file>:
9979 <example>
9980 dpkg-distaddfile <var>filename</var> <var>section</var> <var>priority</var>
9981 </example>
9982 The <var>filename</var> is relative to the directory where
9983 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> will expect to find it - this
9984 is usually the directory above the top level of the source
9985 tree. The <file>debian/rules</file> target should put the
9986 file there just before or just after calling
9987 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn>.
9988 </p>
9991 The <var>section</var> and <var>priority</var> are passed
9992 unchanged into the resulting <file>.changes</file> file.
9993 </p>
9994 </sect1>
9997 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-genchanges">
9998 <heading>
9999 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> - generates a <file>.changes</file>
10000 upload control file
10001 </heading>
10004 This program is usually called by package-independent
10005 automatic building scripts such as
10006 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, but it may also be called
10007 by hand.
10008 </p>
10011 It is usually called in the top level of a built source
10012 tree, and when invoked with no arguments will print out a
10013 straightforward <file>.changes</file> file based on the
10014 information in the source package's changelog and control
10015 file and the binary and source packages which should have
10016 been built.
10017 </p>
10018 </sect1>
10021 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog">
10022 <heading>
10023 <prgn>dpkg-parsechangelog</prgn> - produces parsed
10024 representation of a changelog
10025 </heading>
10028 This program is used internally by
10029 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> et al. It may also occasionally
10030 be useful in <file>debian/rules</file> and elsewhere. It
10031 parses a changelog, <file>debian/changelog</file> by default,
10032 and prints a control-file format representation of the
10033 information in it to standard output.
10034 </p>
10035 </sect1>
10037 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-architecture">
10038 <heading>
10039 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> - information about the build and
10040 host system
10041 </heading>
10044 This program can be used manually, but is also invoked by
10045 <tt>dpkg-buildpackage</tt> or <file>debian/rules</file> to set
10046 environment or make variables which specify the build and host
10047 architecture for the package building process.
10048 </p>
10049 </sect1>
10050 </sect>
10052 <sect id="pkg-sourcetree">
10053 <heading>The Debianised source tree</heading>
10056 The source archive scheme described later is intended to
10057 allow a Debianised source tree with some associated control
10058 information to be reproduced and transported easily. The
10059 Debianised source tree is a version of the original program
10060 with certain files added for the benefit of the
10061 Debianisation process, and with any other changes required
10062 made to the rest of the source code and installation
10063 scripts.
10064 </p>
10067 The extra files created for Debian are in the subdirectory
10068 <file>debian</file> of the top level of the Debianised source
10069 tree. They are described below.
10070 </p>
10072 <sect1 id="pkg-debianrules">
10073 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> - the main building script</heading>
10076 See <ref id="debianrules">.
10077 </p>
10078 </sect1>
10080 <sect1 id="pkg-srcsubstvars">
10081 <heading><file>debian/substvars</file> and variable substitutions</heading>
10084 See <ref id="substvars">.
10085 </p>
10087 </sect1>
10089 <sect1>
10090 <heading><file>debian/files</file></heading>
10093 See <ref id="debianfiles">.
10094 </p>
10095 </sect1>
10097 <sect1><heading><file>debian/tmp</file>
10098 </heading>
10101 This is the canonical temporary location for the
10102 construction of binary packages by the <tt>binary</tt>
10103 target. The directory <file>tmp</file> serves as the root of
10104 the file system tree as it is being constructed (for
10105 example, by using the package's upstream makefiles install
10106 targets and redirecting the output there), and it also
10107 contains the <tt>DEBIAN</tt> subdirectory. See <ref
10108 id="pkg-bincreating">.
10109 </p>
10112 If several binary packages are generated from the same
10113 source tree it is usual to use several
10114 <file>debian/tmp<var>something</var></file> directories, for
10115 example <file>tmp-a</file> or <file>tmp-doc</file>.
10116 </p>
10119 Whatever <file>tmp</file> directories are created and used by
10120 <tt>binary</tt> must of course be removed by the
10121 <tt>clean</tt> target.</p></sect1>
10122 </sect>
10125 <sect id="pkg-sourcearchives"><heading>Source packages as archives
10126 </heading>
10129 As it exists on the FTP site, a Debian source package
10130 consists of three related files. You must have the right
10131 versions of all three to be able to use them.
10132 </p>
10135 <taglist>
10136 <tag>Debian source control file - <tt>.dsc</tt></tag>
10137 <item>
10138 This file is a control file used by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
10139 to extract a source package.
10140 See <ref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">.
10141 </item>
10143 <tag>
10144 Original source archive -
10145 <file>
10146 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz
10147 </file>
10148 </tag>
10150 <item>
10152 This is a compressed (with <tt>gzip -9</tt>)
10153 <prgn>tar</prgn> file containing the source code from
10154 the upstream authors of the program.
10155 </p>
10156 </item>
10158 <tag>
10159 Debianisation diff -
10160 <file>
10161 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream_version-revision</var>.diff.gz
10162 </file>
10163 </tag>
10164 <item>
10167 This is a unified context diff (<tt>diff -u</tt>)
10168 giving the changes which are required to turn the
10169 original source into the Debian source. These changes
10170 may only include editing and creating plain files.
10171 The permissions of files, the targets of symbolic
10172 links and the characteristics of special files or
10173 pipes may not be changed and no files may be removed
10174 or renamed.
10175 </p>
10178 All the directories in the diff must exist, except the
10179 <file>debian</file> subdirectory of the top of the source
10180 tree, which will be created by
10181 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> if necessary when unpacking.
10182 </p>
10185 The <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> program will
10186 automatically make the <file>debian/rules</file> file
10187 executable (see below).</p></item>
10188 </taglist>
10189 </p>
10192 If there is no original source code - for example, if the
10193 package is specially prepared for Debian or the Debian
10194 maintainer is the same as the upstream maintainer - the
10195 format is slightly different: then there is no diff, and the
10196 tarfile is named
10197 <file><var>package</var>_<var>version</var>.tar.gz</file>,
10198 and preferably contains a directory named
10199 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.
10200 </p>
10201 </sect>
10203 <sect>
10204 <heading>Unpacking a Debian source package without <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn></heading>
10207 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> is the recommended way to unpack a
10208 Debian source package. However, if it is not available it
10209 is possible to unpack a Debian source archive as follows:
10210 <enumlist compact="compact">
10211 <item>
10213 Untar the tarfile, which will create a <file>.orig</file>
10214 directory.</p>
10215 </item>
10216 <item>
10217 <p>Rename the <file>.orig</file> directory to
10218 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.</p>
10219 </item>
10220 <item>
10222 Create the subdirectory <file>debian</file> at the top of
10223 the source tree.</p>
10224 </item>
10225 <item><p>Apply the diff using <tt>patch -p0</tt>.</p>
10226 </item>
10227 <item><p>Untar the tarfile again if you want a copy of the original
10228 source code alongside the Debianised version.</p>
10229 </item>
10230 </enumlist>
10233 It is not possible to generate a valid Debian source archive
10234 without using <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>. In particular,
10235 attempting to use <prgn>diff</prgn> directly to generate the
10236 <file>.diff.gz</file> file will not work.
10237 </p>
10239 <sect1>
10240 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
10243 The source package may not contain any hard links
10244 <footnote>
10245 This is not currently detected when building source
10246 packages, but only when extracting
10247 them.
10248 </footnote>
10249 <footnote>
10250 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
10251 future, but would require a fair amount of
10252 work.
10253 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
10254 setgid files.
10255 <footnote>
10256 Setgid directories are allowed.
10257 </footnote>
10258 </p>
10261 The source packaging tools manage the changes between the
10262 original and Debianised source using <prgn>diff</prgn> and
10263 <prgn>patch</prgn>. Turning the original source tree as
10264 included in the <file>.orig.tar.gz</file> into the debianised
10265 source must not involve any changes which cannot be
10266 handled by these tools. Problematic changes which cause
10267 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to halt with an error when
10268 building the source package are:
10269 <list compact="compact">
10270 <item><p>Adding or removing symbolic links, sockets or pipes.</p>
10271 </item>
10272 <item><p>Changing the targets of symbolic links.</p>
10273 </item>
10274 <item><p>Creating directories, other than <file>debian</file>.</p>
10275 </item>
10276 <item><p>Changes to the contents of binary files.</p></item>
10277 </list> Changes which cause <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to
10278 print a warning but continue anyway are:
10279 <list compact="compact">
10280 <item>
10282 Removing files, directories or symlinks.
10283 <footnote>
10284 Renaming a file is not treated specially - it is
10285 seen as the removal of the old file (which
10286 generates a warning, but is otherwise ignored),
10287 and the creation of the new one.
10288 </footnote>
10289 </p>
10290 </item>
10291 <item>
10293 Changed text files which are missing the usual final
10294 newline (either in the original or the modified
10295 source tree).
10296 </p>
10297 </item>
10298 </list>
10299 Changes which are not represented, but which are not detected by
10300 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, are:
10301 <list compact="compact">
10302 <item><p>Changing the permissions of files (other than
10303 <file>debian/rules</file>) and directories.</p></item>
10304 </list>
10305 </p>
10308 The <file>debian</file> directory and <file>debian/rules</file>
10309 are handled specially by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - before
10310 applying the changes it will create the <file>debian</file>
10311 directory, and afterwards it will make
10312 <file>debian/rules</file> world-executable.
10313 </p>
10314 </sect1>
10315 </sect>
10316 </appendix>
10318 <appendix id="pkg-controlfields">
10319 <heading>Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10322 Many of the tools in the <prgn>dpkg</prgn> suite manipulate
10323 data in a common format, known as control files. Binary and
10324 source packages have control data as do the <file>.changes</file>
10325 files which control the installation of uploaded files, and
10326 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
10327 format.
10328 </p>
10330 <sect>
10331 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
10334 See <ref id="controlsyntax">.
10335 </p>
10338 It is important to note that there are several fields which
10339 are optional as far as <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and the related
10340 tools are concerned, but which must appear in every Debian
10341 package, or whose omission may cause problems.
10342 </p>
10343 </sect>
10345 <sect>
10346 <heading>List of fields</heading>
10349 See <ref id="controlfieldslist">.
10350 </p>
10353 This section now contains only the fields that didn't belong
10354 to the Policy manual.
10355 </p>
10357 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Filename">
10358 <heading><tt>Filename</tt> and <tt>MSDOS-Filename</tt></heading>
10361 These fields in <tt>Packages</tt> files give the
10362 filename(s) of (the parts of) a package in the
10363 distribution directories, relative to the root of the
10364 Debian hierarchy. If the package has been split into
10365 several parts the parts are all listed in order, separated
10366 by spaces.
10367 </p>
10368 </sect1>
10370 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Size">
10371 <heading><tt>Size</tt> and <tt>MD5sum</tt></heading>
10374 These fields in <file>Packages</file> files give the size (in
10375 bytes, expressed in decimal) and MD5 checksum of the
10376 file(s) which make(s) up a binary package in the
10377 distribution. If the package is split into several parts
10378 the values for the parts are listed in order, separated by
10379 spaces.
10380 </p>
10381 </sect1>
10383 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Status">
10384 <heading><tt>Status</tt></heading>
10387 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records
10388 whether the user wants a package installed, removed or
10389 left alone, whether it is broken (requiring
10390 re-installation) or not and what its current state on the
10391 system is. Each of these pieces of information is a
10392 single word.
10393 </p>
10394 </sect1>
10396 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Config-Version">
10397 <heading><tt>Config-Version</tt></heading>
10400 If a package is not installed or not configured, this
10401 field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records the last
10402 version of the package which was successfully
10403 configured.
10404 </p>
10405 </sect1>
10407 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Conffiles">
10408 <heading><tt>Conffiles</tt></heading>
10411 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file contains
10412 information about the automatically-managed configuration
10413 files held by a package. This field should <em>not</em>
10414 appear anywhere in a package!
10415 </p>
10416 </sect1>
10418 <sect1>
10419 <heading>Obsolete fields</heading>
10422 These are still recognized by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> but should
10423 not appear anywhere any more.
10425 <taglist compact="compact">
10427 <tag><tt>Revision</tt></tag>
10428 <tag><tt>Package-Revision</tt></tag>
10429 <tag><tt>Package_Revision</tt></tag>
10430 <item>
10431 The Debian revision part of the package version was
10432 at one point in a separate control file field. This
10433 field went through several names.
10434 </item>
10436 <tag><tt>Recommended</tt></tag>
10437 <item>Old name for <tt>Recommends</tt>.</item>
10439 <tag><tt>Optional</tt></tag>
10440 <item>Old name for <tt>Suggests</tt>.</item>
10442 <tag><tt>Class</tt></tag>
10443 <item>Old name for <tt>Priority</tt>.</item>
10445 </taglist>
10446 </p>
10447 </sect1>
10448 </sect>
10450 </appendix>
10452 <appendix id="pkg-conffiles">
10453 <heading>Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10456 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can do a certain amount of automatic
10457 handling of package configuration files.
10458 </p>
10461 Whether this mechanism is appropriate depends on a number of
10462 factors, but basically there are two approaches to any
10463 particular configuration file.
10464 </p>
10467 The easy method is to ship a best-effort configuration in the
10468 package, and use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s conffile mechanism to
10469 handle updates. If the user is unlikely to want to edit the
10470 file, but you need them to be able to without losing their
10471 changes, and a new package with a changed version of the file
10472 is only released infrequently, this is a good approach.
10473 </p>
10476 The hard method is to build the configuration file from
10477 scratch in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and to take the
10478 responsibility for fixing any mistakes made in earlier
10479 versions of the package automatically. This will be
10480 appropriate if the file is likely to need to be different on
10481 each system.
10482 </p>
10484 <sect><heading>Automatic handling of configuration files by
10485 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
10486 </heading>
10489 A package may contain a control area file called
10490 <tt>conffiles</tt>. This file should be a list of filenames
10491 of configuration files needing automatic handling, separated
10492 by newlines. The filenames should be absolute pathnames,
10493 and the files referred to should actually exist in the
10494 package.
10495 </p>
10498 When a package is upgraded <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will process
10499 the configuration files during the configuration stage,
10500 shortly before it runs the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>
10501 script,
10502 </p>
10505 For each file it checks to see whether the version of the
10506 file included in the package is the same as the one that was
10507 included in the last version of the package (the one that is
10508 being upgraded from); it also compares the version currently
10509 installed on the system with the one shipped with the last
10510 version.
10511 </p>
10514 If neither the user nor the package maintainer has changed
10515 the file, it is left alone. If one or the other has changed
10516 their version, then the changed version is preferred - i.e.,
10517 if the user edits their file, but the package maintainer
10518 doesn't ship a different version, the user's changes will
10519 stay, silently, but if the maintainer ships a new version
10520 and the user hasn't edited it the new version will be
10521 installed (with an informative message). If both have
10522 changed their version the user is prompted about the problem
10523 and must resolve the differences themselves.
10524 </p>
10527 The comparisons are done by calculating the MD5 message
10528 digests of the files, and storing the MD5 of the file as it
10529 was included in the most recent version of the package.
10530 </p>
10533 When a package is installed for the first time
10534 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will install the file that comes with it,
10535 unless that would mean overwriting a file already on the
10536 file system.
10537 </p>
10540 However, note that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will <em>not</em>
10541 replace a conffile that was removed by the user (or by a
10542 script). This is necessary because with some programs a
10543 missing file produces an effect hard or impossible to
10544 achieve in another way, so that a missing file needs to be
10545 kept that way if the user did it.
10546 </p>
10549 Note that a package should <em>not</em> modify a
10550 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled conffile in its maintainer
10551 scripts. Doing this will lead to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> giving
10552 the user confusing and possibly dangerous options for
10553 conffile update when the package is upgraded.</p>
10554 </sect>
10556 <sect><heading>Fully-featured maintainer script configuration
10557 handling
10558 </heading>
10561 For files which contain site-specific information such as
10562 the hostname and networking details and so forth, it is
10563 better to create the file in the package's
10564 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
10565 </p>
10568 This will typically involve examining the state of the rest
10569 of the system to determine values and other information, and
10570 may involve prompting the user for some information which
10571 can't be obtained some other way.
10572 </p>
10575 When using this method there are a couple of important
10576 issues which should be considered:
10577 </p>
10580 If you discover a bug in the program which generates the
10581 configuration file, or if the format of the file changes
10582 from one version to the next, you will have to arrange for
10583 the postinst script to do something sensible - usually this
10584 will mean editing the installed configuration file to remove
10585 the problem or change the syntax. You will have to do this
10586 very carefully, since the user may have changed the file,
10587 perhaps to fix the very problem that your script is trying
10588 to deal with - you will have to detect these situations and
10589 deal with them correctly.
10590 </p>
10593 If you do go down this route it's probably a good idea to
10594 make the program that generates the configuration file(s) a
10595 separate program in <file>/usr/sbin</file>, by convention called
10596 <file><var>package</var>config</file> and then run that if
10597 appropriate from the post-installation script. The
10598 <tt><var>package</var>config</tt> program should not
10599 unquestioningly overwrite an existing configuration - if its
10600 mode of operation is geared towards setting up a package for
10601 the first time (rather than any arbitrary reconfiguration
10602 later) you should have it check whether the configuration
10603 already exists, and require a <tt>--force</tt> flag to
10604 overwrite it.</p></sect>
10605 </appendix>
10607 <appendix id="pkg-alternatives"><heading>Alternative versions of
10608 an interface - <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> (from old
10609 Packaging Manual)
10610 </heading>
10613 When several packages all provide different versions of the
10614 same program or file it is useful to have the system select a
10615 default, but to allow the system administrator to change it
10616 and have their decisions respected.
10617 </p>
10620 For example, there are several versions of the <prgn>vi</prgn>
10621 editor, and there is no reason to prevent all of them from
10622 being installed at once, each under their own name
10623 (<prgn>nvi</prgn>, <prgn>vim</prgn> or whatever).
10624 Nevertheless it is desirable to have the name <tt>vi</tt>
10625 refer to something, at least by default.
10626 </p>
10629 If all the packages involved cooperate, this can be done with
10630 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>.
10631 </p>
10634 Each package provides its own version under its own name, and
10635 calls <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> in its postinst to
10636 register its version (and again in its prerm to deregister
10637 it).
10638 </p>
10641 See the man page <manref name="update-alternatives"
10642 section="8"> for details.
10643 </p>
10646 If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> does not seem appropriate
10647 you may wish to consider using diversions instead.</p>
10648 </appendix>
10650 <appendix id="pkg-diversions"><heading>Diversions - overriding a
10651 package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)
10652 </heading>
10655 It is possible to have <prgn>dpkg</prgn> not overwrite a file
10656 when it reinstalls the package it belongs to, and to have it
10657 put the file from the package somewhere else instead.
10658 </p>
10661 This can be used locally to override a package's version of a
10662 file, or by one package to override another's version (or
10663 provide a wrapper for it).
10664 </p>
10667 Before deciding to use a diversion, read <ref
10668 id="pkg-alternatives"> to see if you really want a diversion
10669 rather than several alternative versions of a program.
10670 </p>
10673 There is a diversion list, which is read by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
10674 and updated by a special program <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>.
10675 Please see <manref name="dpkg-divert" section="8"> for full
10676 details of its operation.
10677 </p>
10680 When a package wishes to divert a file from another, it should
10681 call <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> in its preinst to add the
10682 diversion and rename the existing file. For example,
10683 supposing that a <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn> package wishes to
10684 install a wrapper around <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>:
10685 <example>
10686 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10687 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10688 </example> The <tt>--package smailwrapper</tt> ensures that
10689 <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn>'s copy of <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>
10690 can bypass the diversion and get installed as the true version.
10691 It's safe to add the diversion unconditionally on upgrades since
10692 it will be left unchanged if it already exists, but
10693 <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> will display a message. To suppress that
10694 message, make the command conditional on the version from which
10695 the package is being upgraded:
10696 <example>
10697 if [ upgrade != "$1" ] || dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10698 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10699 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10701 </example> where <tt>1.0-2</tt> is the version at which the
10702 diversion was first added to the package. Running the command
10703 during abort-upgrade is pointless but harmless.
10704 </p>
10707 The postrm has to do the reverse:
10708 <example>
10709 if [ remove = "$1" -o abort-install = "$1" -o disappear = "$1" ]; then
10710 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10711 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10713 </example> If the diversion was added at a particular version, the
10714 postrm should also handle the failure case of upgrading from an
10715 older version (unless the older version is so old that direct
10716 upgrades are no longer supported):
10717 <example>
10718 if [ abort-upgrade = "$1" ] && dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10719 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10720 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10722 </example> where <tt>1.02-2</tt> is the version at which the
10723 diversion was first added to the package. The postrm should not
10724 remove the diversion on upgrades both because there's no reason to
10725 remove the diversion only to immediately re-add it and since the
10726 postrm of the old package is run after unpacking so the removal of
10727 the diversion will fail.
10728 </p>
10731 Do not attempt to divert a file which is vitally important for
10732 the system's operation - when using <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>
10733 there is a time, after it has been diverted but before
10734 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> has installed the new version, when the file
10735 does not exist.</p>
10736 </appendix>
10738 </book>
10739 </debiandoc>
10740 <!-- Local variables: -->
10741 <!-- indent-tabs-mode: t -->
10742 <!-- End: -->
10743 <!-- vim:set ai et sts=2 sw=2 tw=76: -->